1-877-275-7048|Free delivery — 48 states|20-year warranty on 12ga
In Stock & Ready to Ship | Lead Time: 4–8 Weeks | RTO from $49/mo

RV Covers For Sale

Shop 35+ prefab steel carport sizes from $1,195. Regular, A-Frame & vertical roof styles in 12 or 14 gauge. Free delivery & professional installation on every tubular steel order across all 48 states.

$1,195
Starting Price
35+
Sizes In Stock
20yr
Warranty — 12ga
48
States Covered
Factory-Direct Pricing
20-Year Warranty — 12 Gauge
A+ BBB Accredited Since 2004
Free Delivery — All 48 States
Free Professional Installation Included
RTO & Easy Financing from $49/mo
Balance Due After Install — Not Before
35+ Carport Sizes In Stock
Factory-Direct Pricing
20-Year Warranty — 12 Gauge
A+ BBB Accredited Since 2004
Free Delivery — All 48 States
Free Professional Installation Included
RTO & Easy Financing from $49/mo
Balance Due After Install — Not Before
35+ Carport Sizes In Stock

Filter Carports

Filters
Product Vehicles
Filter by State

Showing 2041–2080 of 2330 resultsSorted by price: low to high

Tan metal garage with brown roll-up doors and white fleet pickups at golden hour

30×100 Contractor Supply & Van Bay

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×100 Contractor Supply & Van Bay | Steel and Stud, From $48,550

12

30×100 Contractor Supply & Van Bay
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$55,350$48,550SAVE $6,800
or $1011/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×100Contractor Supply & Van Bay

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×100 Contractor Supply & Van Bay, engineered for code-compliant business use.

Built for business owners who need fast permitted occupancy, this 30×100 contractor supply & van bay packs 3000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Plumbers, electricians, and framers pull a service van straight into the.

You’re viewing:Contractor Supply & Van Bay·Size30×100·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$48,550$55,350Save $6,800
or as low as $1011/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×100
30×100
this size
$48,550
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 3,000 sq ft enclosed
  • Fully Enclosed
  • Van Pull-In
  • 26 GA Panels
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X100-CONTRACTOR-SUPPLBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your contractor-storage layout.

30 feet wide × 100 feet long. Built for business owners who need fast permitted occupancy, this 30×100 contractor supply & van bay packs 3000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell.

↑ WINDOW WALL ↑Inventory racksLoading bayOffice / Desk30′ × 100′ · 3,000 sq ft · contractor-storage layout

Inventory racks · Loading bay · Office / Desk

Inventory racks at the front, loading bay in the middle, office / desk at the rear. Plumbers, electricians, and framers pull a service van straight into the end bay of the 30×100 and use the remaining 80 feet as a walk-in supply room for fittings, conduit, and fixtures.

💡 Pro tip:Van Pull-In.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×100 Contractor Supply & Van Bay in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Contractor Supply & Van Bay.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
3,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×100 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Contractor Supply & Van Bay spec sheet.

Width30′
Length100′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space3,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Contractor Supply & Van Bay.

DAILY USEEveryday contractor supply & van bay
Everyday contractor supply & van bay
3,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a contractor supply & van bay.
STORAGE OVERFLOWcontractor supply & van bay + seasonal storage
contractor supply & van bay + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×100 Contractor Supply & Van Bay, what makes it different.

3,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$1011/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×100 contractor supply & van bay is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $1011/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×100?

3,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 100′ footprint with 3,000 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $24,000–$36,000 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Contractor Supply & Van Bay shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×100 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×100 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×100 Contractor Supply & Van Bay buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×100 Contractor Supply & Van Bay

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Contractor Supply & Van Bay · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×101×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$13,500+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Contractor Supply & Van Bay also viewed:

🎯 30×100

RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor

30×100 rv & travel trailer storage corridor configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor →

🌾 30×100

Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed

30×100 hay & equipment run-in shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed →

🏡 30×100

Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

30×100 long workshop & hobby bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Long Workshop & Hobby Bench →

🎯 30×100

Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏭 30×100

Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack →

🌾 30×100

Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow →

🏢 30×100

Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

30×100 outdoor shooting range cover configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Outdoor Shooting Range Cover →

🏡 30×100

Property-Line Detached Garage

30×100 property-line detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Property-Line Detached Garage →

🌾 30×100

Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench →

🏛️ 30×100

Park & Trailhead Pavilion

30×100 park & trailhead pavilion configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Park & Trailhead Pavilion →

🏭 30×100

Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

30×100 carwash & detail drive-through configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Carwash & Detail Drive-Through →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Contractor Supply & Van Bay questions, answered.

How much does a 30×100 contractor supply & van bay cost?

A 30×100 contractor supply & van bay from Steel and Stud starts at $48,550 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $1011/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×100 contractor supply & van bay price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud contractor supply & van bay ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×100 contractor supply & van bay?

Almost always for 3,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud contractor supply & van bay different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×100 contractor supply & van bay need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×100 contractor supply & van bay delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×100 contractor supply & van bay without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $1011/month on a 30×100 contractor supply & van bay.

What warranty comes with the 30×100 contractor supply & van bay?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×100 contractor supply & van bay in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does the 30×100 contractor supply & van bay meet IBC commercial code?

Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.

Ready to build?

Your Contractor Supply & Van Bay quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$48,550.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Tan metal garage with brown roll-up doors and white fleet pickups at golden hour

30×100 Contractor Supply & Van Bay

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$48,550.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Tan prefab metal building repair shop in autumn with flatbed tow truck delivering a sedan

30×100 Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×100 Long Workshop & Hobby Bench | Steel and Stud, From $46,700

12

30×100 Long Workshop & Hobby Bench
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$53,250$46,700SAVE $6,550
or $973/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×100Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×100 Long Workshop & Hobby Bench, built for daily backyard use.

Built for homeowners who want more covered space, this 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench packs 3000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Homeowners with a side-yard run set up a 100-foot workbench down one wall and.

You’re viewing:Long Workshop & Hobby Bench·Size30×100·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$46,700$53,250Save $6,550
or as low as $973/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×100
30×100
this size
$46,700
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 3,000 sq ft enclosed
  • A-Frame Roof
  • R-19 Insulation
  • Walk-In Door
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X100-LONG-WORKSHOP-HOBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-station shop.

30 feet wide × 100 feet long. Separates dusty + clean operations. Built for homeowners who want more covered space, this 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench packs 3000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell.

Wood + metal benchesCNC / TABLE-SAW CENTERFinishing room + Material storage30′ × 100′ · 3,000 sq ft · multi-station shop

Wood + metal benches · CNC / table-saw center · Finishing room + Material storage

Wood + metal benches at the front, cnc / table-saw center in the middle, finishing room + material storage at the rear. Capacity: multi-craft shop / small business. Homeowners with a side-yard run set up a 100-foot workbench down one wall and rolling tool chests down the other.

💡 Pro tip:R-19 Insulation. Size affords: CNC table, paint booth, office.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×100 Long Workshop & Hobby Bench in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Long Workshop & Hobby Bench.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
3,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×100 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Long Workshop & Hobby Bench spec sheet.

Width30′
Length100′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space3,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Long Workshop & Hobby Bench.

DAILY USEEveryday long workshop & hobby bench
Everyday long workshop & hobby bench
3,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a long workshop & hobby bench.
STORAGE OVERFLOWlong workshop & hobby bench + seasonal storage
long workshop & hobby bench + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×100 Long Workshop & Hobby Bench, what makes it different.

3,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$973/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $973/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×100?

3,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 100′ footprint with 3,000 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $24,000–$36,000 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Long Workshop & Hobby Bench shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×100 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×100 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×100 Long Workshop & Hobby Bench buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×100 Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Long Workshop & Hobby Bench · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×101×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$13,500+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Long Workshop & Hobby Bench also viewed:

🎯 30×100

RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor

30×100 rv & travel trailer storage corridor configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor →

🌾 30×100

Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed

30×100 hay & equipment run-in shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed →

🏢 30×100

Contractor Supply & Van Bay

30×100 contractor supply & van bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Supply & Van Bay →

🎯 30×100

Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏭 30×100

Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack →

🌾 30×100

Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow →

🏢 30×100

Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

30×100 outdoor shooting range cover configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Outdoor Shooting Range Cover →

🏡 30×100

Property-Line Detached Garage

30×100 property-line detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Property-Line Detached Garage →

🌾 30×100

Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench →

🏛️ 30×100

Park & Trailhead Pavilion

30×100 park & trailhead pavilion configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Park & Trailhead Pavilion →

🏭 30×100

Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

30×100 carwash & detail drive-through configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Carwash & Detail Drive-Through →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Long Workshop & Hobby Bench questions, answered.

How much does a 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench cost?

A 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench from Steel and Stud starts at $46,700 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $973/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud long workshop & hobby bench ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench?

Almost always for 3,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud long workshop & hobby bench different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $973/month on a 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench.

What warranty comes with the 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does a 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench add resale value to my home?

An enclosed 30×100 long workshop & hobby bench typically adds $24,000–$36,000 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.

Ready to build?

Your Long Workshop & Hobby Bench quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$46,700.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Tan prefab metal building repair shop in autumn with flatbed tow truck delivering a sedan

30×100 Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$46,700.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Tan steel garage at a lakefront with Class C motorhome, camper inside, and bass boat

30×100 Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×100 Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage | Steel and Stud, From $46,700

12

30×100 Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$53,250$46,700SAVE $6,550
or $973/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×100Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×100 Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage, built for hobby and recreational use.

Built for recreational use without site-build cost, this 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage packs 3000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Marina-adjacent property owners stage 2-3 bass boats, jet ski trailers.

You’re viewing:Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage·Size30×100·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$46,700$53,250Save $6,550
or as low as $973/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×100
30×100
this size
$46,700
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 3,000 sq ft enclosed
  • Vertical Roof
  • Hurricane Cert
  • Roll-Up Door
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X100-SINGLE-LANE-BOATBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your boat-storage layout.

30 feet wide × 100 feet long. Built for recreational use without site-build cost, this 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage packs 3000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell.

Boat + trailerDaily driverOutboard / rinse30′ × 100′ · 3,000 sq ft · boat-storage layout

Boat + trailer · Daily driver · Outboard / rinse

Boat + trailer at the front, daily driver in the middle, outboard / rinse at the rear. Marina-adjacent property owners stage 2-3 bass boats, jet ski trailers, and a center-console end-to-end.

💡 Pro tip:Hurricane Cert.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×100 Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
3,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×100 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage spec sheet.

Width30′
Length100′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space3,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage.

DAILY USEEveryday single-lane boat & trailer storage
Everyday single-lane boat & trailer storage
3,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a single-lane boat & trailer storage.
STORAGE OVERFLOWsingle-lane boat & trailer storage + seasonal storage
single-lane boat & trailer storage + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×100 Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage, what makes it different.

3,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$973/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $973/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×100?

3,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 100′ footprint with 3,000 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $24,000–$36,000 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×100 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×100 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×100 Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×100 Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×101×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$13,500+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage also viewed:

🎯 30×100

RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor

30×100 rv & travel trailer storage corridor configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor →

🌾 30×100

Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed

30×100 hay & equipment run-in shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed →

🏢 30×100

Contractor Supply & Van Bay

30×100 contractor supply & van bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Supply & Van Bay →

🏡 30×100

Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

30×100 long workshop & hobby bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Long Workshop & Hobby Bench →

🏭 30×100

Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack →

🌾 30×100

Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow →

🏢 30×100

Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

30×100 outdoor shooting range cover configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Outdoor Shooting Range Cover →

🏡 30×100

Property-Line Detached Garage

30×100 property-line detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Property-Line Detached Garage →

🌾 30×100

Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench →

🏛️ 30×100

Park & Trailhead Pavilion

30×100 park & trailhead pavilion configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Park & Trailhead Pavilion →

🏭 30×100

Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

30×100 carwash & detail drive-through configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Carwash & Detail Drive-Through →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage questions, answered.

How much does a 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage cost?

A 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage from Steel and Stud starts at $46,700 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $973/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud single-lane boat & trailer storage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage?

Almost always for 3,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud single-lane boat & trailer storage different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $973/month on a 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage.

What warranty comes with the 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Can I insulate the 30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage for year-round use?

Yes, Steel and Stud offers R-13 wall + R-19 ceiling insulation packages, and the interior is drywall-ready. Most owners finish a single-lane boat & trailer storage to a livable retreat in 2–3 weekends. Add a mini-split HVAC at checkout for full four-season comfort.

Ready to build?

Your Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$46,700.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Tan steel garage at a lakefront with Class C motorhome, camper inside, and bass boat

30×100 Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$46,700.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
White prefab metal building with red roof and cupolas housing a tractor, ATV, and mower

30×100 Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×100 Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack | Steel and Stud, From $48,950

12

30×100 Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$55,800$48,950SAVE $6,850
or $1020/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×100Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×100 Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.

Our 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack fits 30-foot widths and 100-foot lengths to give you a heavy-gauge frame rated for forklifts and machinery. Steel fabricators, irrigation contractors, and pool builders rack.

You’re viewing:Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack·Size30×100·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$48,950$55,800Save $6,850
or as low as $1020/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×100
30×100
this size
$48,950
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 3,000 sq ft enclosed
  • Open Gables
  • Forklift Clearance
  • 14 GA Frame
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X100-PIPE-REBAR-LONG-Built:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your pipe, rebar & long-stock rack layout.

30 feet wide × 100 feet long. Our 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack fits 30-foot widths and 100-foot lengths to give you a heavy-gauge frame rated for forklifts and machinery.

Pickup BayWORKSHOP30′ × 100′ · 3,000 sq ft · pipe, rebar & long-stock rack layout

Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack layout.

Our 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack fits 30-foot widths and 100-foot lengths to give you a heavy-gauge frame rated for forklifts and machinery. Steel fabricators, irrigation contractors, and pool builders rack 20-foot and 40-foot lengths inside cantilever stands along the 100-foot wall. Forklift access through both gables turns the building into a covered drive-through pull yard for long material.

💡 Pro tip:Forklift Clearance.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×100 Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
3,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×100 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack spec sheet.

Width30′
Length100′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space3,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack.

DAILY USEEveryday pipe, rebar & long-stock rack
Everyday pipe, rebar & long-stock rack
3,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a pipe, rebar & long-stock rack.
STORAGE OVERFLOWpipe, rebar & long-stock rack + seasonal storage
pipe, rebar & long-stock rack + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×100 Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack, what makes it different.

3,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$1020/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $1020/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×100?

3,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 100′ footprint with 3,000 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $24,000–$36,000 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×100 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×100 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×100 Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×100 Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×101×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$13,500+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack also viewed:

🎯 30×100

RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor

30×100 rv & travel trailer storage corridor configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor →

🌾 30×100

Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed

30×100 hay & equipment run-in shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed →

🏢 30×100

Contractor Supply & Van Bay

30×100 contractor supply & van bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Supply & Van Bay →

🏡 30×100

Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

30×100 long workshop & hobby bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Long Workshop & Hobby Bench →

🎯 30×100

Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage →

🌾 30×100

Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow →

🏢 30×100

Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

30×100 outdoor shooting range cover configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Outdoor Shooting Range Cover →

🏡 30×100

Property-Line Detached Garage

30×100 property-line detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Property-Line Detached Garage →

🌾 30×100

Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench →

🏛️ 30×100

Park & Trailhead Pavilion

30×100 park & trailhead pavilion configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Park & Trailhead Pavilion →

🏭 30×100

Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

30×100 carwash & detail drive-through configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Carwash & Detail Drive-Through →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack questions, answered.

How much does a 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack cost?

A 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack from Steel and Stud starts at $48,950 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $1020/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud pipe, rebar & long-stock rack ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack?

Almost always for 3,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud pipe, rebar & long-stock rack different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $1020/month on a 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack.

What warranty comes with the 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack handle heavy equipment and forklifts?

Standard 30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.

Ready to build?

Your Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$48,950.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
White prefab metal building with red roof and cupolas housing a tractor, ATV, and mower

30×100 Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$48,950.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Green steel building horse barn at twilight with lit aisle and landscape path lighting

30×100 Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×100 Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow | Steel and Stud, From $47,350

12

30×100 Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$54,000$47,350SAVE $6,650
or $986/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×100Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×100 Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow, built for farm and ranch demands.

30×100 delivers 3000 sq ft of rugged single-row horse stall shedrow space. Hobby farmers convert the 30×100 into eight 12-foot shedrow stalls with a 4-foot tack area. Dutch doors face outward along the long sidewall for.

You’re viewing:Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow·Size30×100·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$47,350$54,000Save $6,650
or as low as $986/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×100
30×100
this size
$47,350
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 3,000 sq ft enclosed
  • Dutch Doors
  • Insulated Roof
  • Wood Trim
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X100-SINGLE-ROW-HORSEBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-stall stable.

30 feet wide × 100 feet long. Full-height clearance supports hay loft (~280 bales). 30×100 delivers 3000 sq ft of rugged single-row horse stall shedrow space.

7 stalls + tack12-FT CENTER AISLEHay loft + Wash bay30′ × 100′ · 3,000 sq ft · multi-stall stable

7 stalls + tack · 12-ft center aisle · Hay loft + Wash bay

7 stalls + tack at the front, 12-ft center aisle in the middle, hay loft + wash bay at the rear. Capacity: 7 horses, full stable ops. Hobby farmers convert the 30×100 into eight 12-foot shedrow stalls with a 4-foot tack area.

💡 Pro tip:Dutch Doors. Size affords: hay loft, wash bay with hot water, feed room.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×100 Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
3,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×100 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow spec sheet.

Width30′
Length100′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space3,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow.

DAILY USEEveryday single-row horse stall shedrow
Everyday single-row horse stall shedrow
3,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a single-row horse stall shedrow.
STORAGE OVERFLOWsingle-row horse stall shedrow + seasonal storage
single-row horse stall shedrow + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×100 Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow, what makes it different.

3,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$986/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $986/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×100?

3,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 100′ footprint with 3,000 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $24,000–$36,000 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×100 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×100 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×100 Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×100 Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×101×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$13,500+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow also viewed:

🎯 30×100

RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor

30×100 rv & travel trailer storage corridor configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor →

🌾 30×100

Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed

30×100 hay & equipment run-in shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed →

🏢 30×100

Contractor Supply & Van Bay

30×100 contractor supply & van bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Supply & Van Bay →

🏡 30×100

Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

30×100 long workshop & hobby bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Long Workshop & Hobby Bench →

🎯 30×100

Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏭 30×100

Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack →

🏢 30×100

Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

30×100 outdoor shooting range cover configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Outdoor Shooting Range Cover →

🏡 30×100

Property-Line Detached Garage

30×100 property-line detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Property-Line Detached Garage →

🌾 30×100

Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench →

🏛️ 30×100

Park & Trailhead Pavilion

30×100 park & trailhead pavilion configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Park & Trailhead Pavilion →

🏭 30×100

Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

30×100 carwash & detail drive-through configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Carwash & Detail Drive-Through →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow questions, answered.

How much does a 30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow cost?

A 30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow from Steel and Stud starts at $47,350 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $986/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud single-row horse stall shedrow ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow?

Almost always for 3,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud single-row horse stall shedrow different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $986/month on a 30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow.

What warranty comes with the 30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?

The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.

Ready to build?

Your Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$47,350.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Green steel building horse barn at twilight with lit aisle and landscape path lighting

30×100 Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$47,350.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Tan metal garage with lean-to porch sheltering classic car and vintage truck inside

30×100 Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×100 Outdoor Shooting Range Cover | Steel and Stud, From $48,550

12

30×100 Outdoor Shooting Range Cover
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$55,350$48,550SAVE $6,800
or $1011/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×100Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×100 Outdoor Shooting Range Cover, engineered for code-compliant business use.

Built for business owners who need fast permitted occupancy, this 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover packs 3000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Gun clubs and private ranges cover a 100-foot firing line with an.

You’re viewing:Outdoor Shooting Range Cover·Size30×100·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$48,550$55,350Save $6,800
or as low as $1011/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×100
30×100
this size
$48,550
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 3,000 sq ft enclosed
  • Open Front
  • Low Eave
  • Vertical Roof
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X100-OUTDOOR-SHOOTINGBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your outdoor shooting range cover layout.

30 feet wide × 100 feet long. Built for business owners who need fast permitted occupancy, this 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover packs 3000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell.

Car 1Car 2OFFICE30′ × 100′ · 3,000 sq ft · outdoor shooting range cover layout

Outdoor Shooting Range Cover layout.

Built for business owners who need fast permitted occupancy, this 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover packs 3000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Gun clubs and private ranges cover a 100-foot firing line with an open-sided 30×100 to keep shooters dry without obstructing target sightlines. The narrow depth puts the roof directly over the bench while leaving downrange visibility wide open.

💡 Pro tip:Low Eave.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×100 Outdoor Shooting Range Cover in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Outdoor Shooting Range Cover.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
3,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×100 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Outdoor Shooting Range Cover spec sheet.

Width30′
Length100′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space3,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Outdoor Shooting Range Cover.

DAILY USEEveryday outdoor shooting range cover
Everyday outdoor shooting range cover
3,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a outdoor shooting range cover.
STORAGE OVERFLOWoutdoor shooting range cover + seasonal storage
outdoor shooting range cover + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×100 Outdoor Shooting Range Cover, what makes it different.

3,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$1011/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $1011/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×100?

3,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 100′ footprint with 3,000 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $24,000–$36,000 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Outdoor Shooting Range Cover shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×100 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×100 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×100 Outdoor Shooting Range Cover buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×100 Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Outdoor Shooting Range Cover · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×101×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$13,500+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Outdoor Shooting Range Cover also viewed:

🎯 30×100

RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor

30×100 rv & travel trailer storage corridor configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor →

🌾 30×100

Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed

30×100 hay & equipment run-in shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed →

🏢 30×100

Contractor Supply & Van Bay

30×100 contractor supply & van bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Supply & Van Bay →

🏡 30×100

Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

30×100 long workshop & hobby bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Long Workshop & Hobby Bench →

🎯 30×100

Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏭 30×100

Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack →

🌾 30×100

Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow →

🏡 30×100

Property-Line Detached Garage

30×100 property-line detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Property-Line Detached Garage →

🌾 30×100

Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench →

🏛️ 30×100

Park & Trailhead Pavilion

30×100 park & trailhead pavilion configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Park & Trailhead Pavilion →

🏭 30×100

Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

30×100 carwash & detail drive-through configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Carwash & Detail Drive-Through →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Outdoor Shooting Range Cover questions, answered.

How much does a 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover cost?

A 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover from Steel and Stud starts at $48,550 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $1011/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud outdoor shooting range cover ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover?

Almost always for 3,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud outdoor shooting range cover different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $1011/month on a 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover.

What warranty comes with the 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does the 30×100 outdoor shooting range cover meet IBC commercial code?

Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.

Ready to build?

Your Outdoor Shooting Range Cover quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$48,550.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Tan metal garage with lean-to porch sheltering classic car and vintage truck inside

30×100 Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$48,550.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Black metal garage with six red roll-up doors and cars on commercial lot

30×100 Property-Line Detached Garage

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×100 Property-Line Detached Garage | Steel and Stud, From $46,700

12

30×100 Property-Line Detached Garage
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$53,250$46,700SAVE $6,550
or $973/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×100Property-Line Detached Garage

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×100 Property-Line Detached Garage, built for daily backyard use.

Built for homeowners who want more covered space, this 30×100 property-line detached garage packs 3000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Homeowners on narrow city lots squeeze a single-car-wide detached garage along.

You’re viewing:Property-Line Detached Garage·Size30×100·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$46,700$53,250Save $6,550
or as low as $973/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×100
30×100
this size
$46,700
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 3,000 sq ft enclosed
  • Fully Enclosed
  • Wainscoting
  • Walk-In Door
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X100-PROPERTY-LINE-DEBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-bay garage + shop.

30 feet wide × 100 feet long. Engineered for clear-span over multiple doors. Built for homeowners who want more covered space, this 30×100 property-line detached garage packs 3000 sq ft into a code-compliant shell.

3 vehicle baysWorkshop areaStorage + lift bay30′ × 100′ · 3,000 sq ft · multi-bay garage + shop

3 vehicle bays · Workshop area · Storage + lift bay

3 vehicle bays at the front, workshop area in the middle, storage + lift bay at the rear. Capacity: 3 vehicles + full hobby shop. Homeowners on narrow city lots squeeze a single-car-wide detached garage along the side setback with room left for a workshop, lawn equipment, and bike storage.

💡 Pro tip:Wainscoting. Size affords: 2-post lift, separated workshop, office.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×100 Property-Line Detached Garage in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Property-Line Detached Garage.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
3,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×100 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Property-Line Detached Garage spec sheet.

Width30′
Length100′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space3,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Property-Line Detached Garage.

DAILY USEEveryday property-line detached garage
Everyday property-line detached garage
3,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a property-line detached garage.
STORAGE OVERFLOWproperty-line detached garage + seasonal storage
property-line detached garage + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×100 Property-Line Detached Garage, what makes it different.

3,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$973/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×100 property-line detached garage is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $973/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×100?

3,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 100′ footprint with 3,000 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $24,000–$36,000 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Property-Line Detached Garage shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×100 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×100 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×100 Property-Line Detached Garage buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×100 Property-Line Detached Garage

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Property-Line Detached Garage · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×101×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$13,500+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Property-Line Detached Garage also viewed:

🎯 30×100

RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor

30×100 rv & travel trailer storage corridor configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor →

🌾 30×100

Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed

30×100 hay & equipment run-in shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed →

🏢 30×100

Contractor Supply & Van Bay

30×100 contractor supply & van bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Supply & Van Bay →

🏡 30×100

Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

30×100 long workshop & hobby bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Long Workshop & Hobby Bench →

🎯 30×100

Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏭 30×100

Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack →

🌾 30×100

Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow →

🏢 30×100

Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

30×100 outdoor shooting range cover configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Outdoor Shooting Range Cover →

🌾 30×100

Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench →

🏛️ 30×100

Park & Trailhead Pavilion

30×100 park & trailhead pavilion configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Park & Trailhead Pavilion →

🏭 30×100

Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

30×100 carwash & detail drive-through configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Carwash & Detail Drive-Through →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Property-Line Detached Garage questions, answered.

How much does a 30×100 property-line detached garage cost?

A 30×100 property-line detached garage from Steel and Stud starts at $46,700 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $973/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×100 property-line detached garage price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud property-line detached garage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×100 property-line detached garage?

Almost always for 3,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud property-line detached garage different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×100 property-line detached garage need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×100 property-line detached garage delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×100 property-line detached garage without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $973/month on a 30×100 property-line detached garage.

What warranty comes with the 30×100 property-line detached garage?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×100 property-line detached garage in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does a 30×100 property-line detached garage add resale value to my home?

An enclosed 30×100 property-line detached garage typically adds $24,000–$36,000 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.

Ready to build?

Your Property-Line Detached Garage quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$46,700.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Black metal garage with six red roll-up doors and cars on commercial lot

30×100 Property-Line Detached Garage

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$46,700.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Sage green prefab metal building cottage shed with white doors surrounded by flower gardens

30×100 Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×100 Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench | Steel and Stud, From $47,350

12

30×100 Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$54,000$47,350SAVE $6,650
or $986/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×100Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×100 Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench, built for farm and ranch demands.

Our 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench fits 30-foot widths and 100-foot lengths to give you durable cover that handles snow, wind, and feed loads. Small-scale growers attach the 30×100 to the long side of a.

You’re viewing:Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench·Size30×100·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$47,350$54,000Save $6,650
or as low as $986/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×100
30×100
this size
$47,350
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 3,000 sq ft enclosed
  • Lean-To Ready
  • R-13 Insulation
  • Walk-In Door
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X100-GREENHOUSE-HEADHBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your greenhouse layout.

30 feet wide × 100 feet long. Our 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench fits 30-foot widths and 100-foot lengths to give you durable cover that handles snow, wind, and feed loads.

Grow tablesPROPAGATIONHeadhouse / Storage30′ × 100′ · 3,000 sq ft · greenhouse layout

Grow tables · Propagation · Headhouse / Storage

Grow tables at the front, propagation in the middle, headhouse / storage at the rear. Small-scale growers attach the 30×100 to the long side of a greenhouse range as a headhouse, potting benches down one wall, propagation racks down the other.

💡 Pro tip:Lean-To Ready.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×100 Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
3,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×100 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench spec sheet.

Width30′
Length100′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space3,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench.

DAILY USEEveryday greenhouse headhouse & potting bench
Everyday greenhouse headhouse & potting bench
3,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a greenhouse headhouse & potting bench.
STORAGE OVERFLOWgreenhouse headhouse & potting bench + seasonal storage
greenhouse headhouse & potting bench + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×100 Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench, what makes it different.

3,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$986/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $986/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×100?

3,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 100′ footprint with 3,000 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $24,000–$36,000 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×100 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×100 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×100 Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×100 Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×101×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$13,500+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench also viewed:

🎯 30×100

RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor

30×100 rv & travel trailer storage corridor configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor →

🌾 30×100

Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed

30×100 hay & equipment run-in shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed →

🏢 30×100

Contractor Supply & Van Bay

30×100 contractor supply & van bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Supply & Van Bay →

🏡 30×100

Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

30×100 long workshop & hobby bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Long Workshop & Hobby Bench →

🎯 30×100

Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏭 30×100

Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack →

🌾 30×100

Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow →

🏢 30×100

Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

30×100 outdoor shooting range cover configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Outdoor Shooting Range Cover →

🏡 30×100

Property-Line Detached Garage

30×100 property-line detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Property-Line Detached Garage →

🏛️ 30×100

Park & Trailhead Pavilion

30×100 park & trailhead pavilion configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Park & Trailhead Pavilion →

🏭 30×100

Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

30×100 carwash & detail drive-through configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Carwash & Detail Drive-Through →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench questions, answered.

How much does a 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench cost?

A 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench from Steel and Stud starts at $47,350 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $986/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud greenhouse headhouse & potting bench ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench?

Almost always for 3,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud greenhouse headhouse & potting bench different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $986/month on a 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench.

What warranty comes with the 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?

The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.

Ready to build?

Your Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$47,350.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Sage green prefab metal building cottage shed with white doors surrounded by flower gardens

30×100 Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$47,350.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Blue steel carport sheltering pickup trucks and an orange tractor on a farm at sunset

30×100 Park & Trailhead Pavilion

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×100 Park & Trailhead Pavilion | Steel and Stud, From $48,650

12

30×100 Park & Trailhead Pavilion
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$55,450$48,650SAVE $6,800
or $1014/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×100Park & Trailhead Pavilion

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×100 Park & Trailhead Pavilion, engineered to code for assembly use.

30×100 delivers 3000 sq ft of public-use park & trailhead pavilion space. Parks departments and trail associations cover a 100-foot bench line with an open-sided 30×100 for shade and rain shelter at trailheads, beach.

You’re viewing:Park & Trailhead Pavilion·Size30×100·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$48,650$55,450Save $6,800
or as low as $1014/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×100
30×100
this size
$48,650
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 3,000 sq ft enclosed
  • Open Sides
  • IBC Certified
  • Vertical Roof
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X100-PARK-TRAILHEAD-PBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your open-cover layout.

30 feet wide × 100 feet long. 30×100 delivers 3000 sq ft of public-use park & trailhead pavilion space.

Cover bayPillar zoneAPPROACH APRON30′ × 100′ · 3,000 sq ft · open-cover layout

Cover bay · Pillar zone · Approach apron

Cover bay at the front, pillar zone in the middle, approach apron at the rear. Parks departments and trail associations cover a 100-foot bench line with an open-sided 30×100 for shade and rain shelter at trailheads, beach parking lots, and event staging areas.

💡 Pro tip:IBC Certified.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×100 Park & Trailhead Pavilion in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Park & Trailhead Pavilion.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
3,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×100 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Park & Trailhead Pavilion spec sheet.

Width30′
Length100′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space3,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Park & Trailhead Pavilion.

DAILY USEEveryday park & trailhead pavilion
Everyday park & trailhead pavilion
3,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a park & trailhead pavilion.
STORAGE OVERFLOWpark & trailhead pavilion + seasonal storage
park & trailhead pavilion + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×100 Park & Trailhead Pavilion, what makes it different.

3,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$1014/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×100 park & trailhead pavilion is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $1014/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×100?

3,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 100′ footprint with 3,000 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $24,000–$36,000 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Park & Trailhead Pavilion shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×100 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×100 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×100 Park & Trailhead Pavilion buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×100 Park & Trailhead Pavilion

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Park & Trailhead Pavilion · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×101×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$13,500+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Park & Trailhead Pavilion also viewed:

🎯 30×100

RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor

30×100 rv & travel trailer storage corridor configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor →

🌾 30×100

Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed

30×100 hay & equipment run-in shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed →

🏢 30×100

Contractor Supply & Van Bay

30×100 contractor supply & van bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Supply & Van Bay →

🏡 30×100

Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

30×100 long workshop & hobby bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Long Workshop & Hobby Bench →

🎯 30×100

Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏭 30×100

Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack →

🌾 30×100

Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow →

🏢 30×100

Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

30×100 outdoor shooting range cover configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Outdoor Shooting Range Cover →

🏡 30×100

Property-Line Detached Garage

30×100 property-line detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Property-Line Detached Garage →

🌾 30×100

Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench →

🏭 30×100

Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

30×100 carwash & detail drive-through configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Carwash & Detail Drive-Through →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Park & Trailhead Pavilion questions, answered.

How much does a 30×100 park & trailhead pavilion cost?

A 30×100 park & trailhead pavilion from Steel and Stud starts at $48,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $1014/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×100 park & trailhead pavilion price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud park & trailhead pavilion ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×100 park & trailhead pavilion?

Almost always for 3,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud park & trailhead pavilion different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×100 park & trailhead pavilion need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×100 park & trailhead pavilion delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×100 park & trailhead pavilion without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $1014/month on a 30×100 park & trailhead pavilion.

What warranty comes with the 30×100 park & trailhead pavilion?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×100 park & trailhead pavilion in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×100 park & trailhead pavilion pass community-use and assembly inspections?

Yes. Steel and Stud’s engineered drawings include load calculations, accessibility paths, and egress widths required by most jurisdictions for assembly and institutional use. Stamped, sealed PE drawings are included free with every order.

Ready to build?

Your Park & Trailhead Pavilion quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$48,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Blue steel carport sheltering pickup trucks and an orange tractor on a farm at sunset

30×100 Park & Trailhead Pavilion

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$48,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Charcoal metal garage with roll-up doors and cars on lifts inside an auto repair shop

30×100 Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×100 Carwash & Detail Drive-Through | Steel and Stud, From $48,950

12

30×100 Carwash & Detail Drive-Through
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$55,800$48,950SAVE $6,850
or $1020/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×100Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×100 Carwash & Detail Drive-Through, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.

Our 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through fits 30-foot widths and 100-foot lengths to give you a heavy-gauge frame rated for forklifts and machinery. Detailers and self-service operators cover a 100-foot wash lane with.

You’re viewing:Carwash & Detail Drive-Through·Size30×100·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$48,950$55,800Save $6,850
or as low as $1020/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×100
30×100
this size
$48,950
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 3,000 sq ft enclosed
  • Open Gables
  • Drive-Through
  • Vertical Roof
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X100-CARWASH-DETAIL-DBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your carwash & detail drive-through layout.

30 feet wide × 100 feet long. Our 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through fits 30-foot widths and 100-foot lengths to give you a heavy-gauge frame rated for forklifts and machinery.

Pickup #1Pickup #2Workshop area30′ × 100′ · 3,000 sq ft · carwash & detail drive-through layout

Carwash & Detail Drive-Through layout.

Our 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through fits 30-foot widths and 100-foot lengths to give you a heavy-gauge frame rated for forklifts and machinery. Detailers and self-service operators cover a 100-foot wash lane with the 30×100 to keep crews and customers dry. The narrow 10-foot width matches a single bay, and the open-gable configuration lets vehicles pull straight through without backing.

💡 Pro tip:Drive-Through.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×100 Carwash & Detail Drive-Through in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Carwash & Detail Drive-Through.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
3,000 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×100 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Carwash & Detail Drive-Through spec sheet.

Width30′
Length100′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space3,000 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Carwash & Detail Drive-Through.

DAILY USEEveryday carwash & detail drive-through
Everyday carwash & detail drive-through
3,000 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a carwash & detail drive-through.
STORAGE OVERFLOWcarwash & detail drive-through + seasonal storage
carwash & detail drive-through + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×100 Carwash & Detail Drive-Through, what makes it different.

3,000sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$1020/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $1020/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×100?

3,000 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 100′ footprint with 3,000 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $24,000–$36,000 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Carwash & Detail Drive-Through shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×100 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×100 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×100 Carwash & Detail Drive-Through buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×100 Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Carwash & Detail Drive-Through · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×101×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$13,500+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Carwash & Detail Drive-Through also viewed:

🎯 30×100

RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor

30×100 rv & travel trailer storage corridor configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV & Travel Trailer Storage Corridor →

🌾 30×100

Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed

30×100 hay & equipment run-in shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hay & Equipment Run-In Shed →

🏢 30×100

Contractor Supply & Van Bay

30×100 contractor supply & van bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Supply & Van Bay →

🏡 30×100

Long Workshop & Hobby Bench

30×100 long workshop & hobby bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Long Workshop & Hobby Bench →

🎯 30×100

Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage

30×100 single-lane boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Lane Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏭 30×100

Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack

30×100 pipe, rebar & long-stock rack configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,950Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Pipe, Rebar & Long-Stock Rack →

🌾 30×100

Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow

30×100 single-row horse stall shedrow configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Single-Row Horse Stall Shedrow →

🏢 30×100

Outdoor Shooting Range Cover

30×100 outdoor shooting range cover configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,550Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Outdoor Shooting Range Cover →

🏡 30×100

Property-Line Detached Garage

30×100 property-line detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$46,700Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Property-Line Detached Garage →

🌾 30×100

Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench

30×100 greenhouse headhouse & potting bench configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$47,350Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Greenhouse Headhouse & Potting Bench →

🏛️ 30×100

Park & Trailhead Pavilion

30×100 park & trailhead pavilion configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$48,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Park & Trailhead Pavilion →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Carwash & Detail Drive-Through questions, answered.

How much does a 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through cost?

A 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through from Steel and Stud starts at $48,950 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $1020/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud carwash & detail drive-through ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through?

Almost always for 3,000+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud carwash & detail drive-through different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $1020/month on a 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through.

What warranty comes with the 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through handle heavy equipment and forklifts?

Standard 30×100 carwash & detail drive-through ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.

Ready to build?

Your Carwash & Detail Drive-Through quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$48,950.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Charcoal metal garage with roll-up doors and cars on lifts inside an auto repair shop

30×100 Carwash & Detail Drive-Through

3,000 sq ft for workshop, fabrication shop, or barndominium

30′ x 100′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×100 steel building delivers 3,000 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$48,950.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Forest green steel garage with tan roll-up door against a wooded hillside

30×24 Three-Car Detached Garage

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×24 Three-Car Detached Garage | Steel and Stud, From $10,650

12

30×24 Three-Car Detached Garage
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$12,150$10,650SAVE $1,500
or $222/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×24Three-Car Detached Garage

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×24 Three-Car Detached Garage, built for daily backyard use.

Looking for a 30×24 three-car detached garage? At 720 sq ft, this footprint suits homeowners adding garage, workshop, or hobby space. Homeowners with three drivers pick the 30×24 because three sedans or two trucks plus.

You’re viewing:Three-Car Detached Garage·Size30×24·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$10,650$12,150Save $1,500
or as low as $222/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×24
30×24
this size
$10,650
30×25
longer
$9,500
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 720 sq ft enclosed
  • 14 GA Frame
  • Vertical Roof
  • 3 Roll-Up Doors
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X24-THREE-CAR-DETACHBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your two-bay garage.

30 feet wide × 24 feet long. Two 9-ft doors, walk-in side entry. Looking for a 30×24 three-car detached garage? At 720 sq ft, this footprint suits homeowners adding garage, workshop, or hobby space.

Vehicle bay 1Vehicle bay 2Workbench / tools30′ × 24′ · 720 sq ft · two-bay garage

Vehicle bay 1 · Vehicle bay 2 · Workbench / tools

Vehicle bay 1 at the front, vehicle bay 2 in the middle, workbench / tools at the rear. Capacity: 3 vehicles + small workshop. Homeowners with three drivers pick the 30×24 because three sedans or two trucks plus a compact fit comfortably across the 30-foot wall.

💡 Pro tip:Free Install. Size affords: lift rough-in, air compressor, shop sink.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×24 Three-Car Detached Garage in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Three-Car Detached Garage.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
720 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×24 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Three-Car Detached Garage spec sheet.

Width30′
Length24′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space720 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Three-Car Detached Garage.

DAILY USEEveryday three-car detached garage
Everyday three-car detached garage
720 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a three-car detached garage.
STORAGE OVERFLOWthree-car detached garage + seasonal storage
three-car detached garage + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×24 Three-Car Detached Garage, what makes it different.

720sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$222/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×24 three-car detached garage is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $222/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×24?

720 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 24′ footprint with 720 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $5,760–$8,640 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Three-Car Detached Garage shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×24 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×24 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×24 Three-Car Detached Garage buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×24 Three-Car Detached Garage

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Three-Car Detached Garage · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×25×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$3,240+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Three-Car Detached Garage also viewed:

🏡 30×24

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay →

🎯 30×24

RV Cover With Side Storage

30×24 rv cover with side storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover With Side Storage →

🌾 30×24

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

30×24 hobby farm equipment shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobby Farm Equipment Shed →

🏢 30×24

Small Business Shop

30×24 small business shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Business Shop →

🏡 30×24

Man Cave or She Shed

30×24 man cave or she shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Man Cave or She Shed →

🌾 30×24

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter →

🏭 30×24

Welding & Fabrication Shop

30×24 welding & fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,900Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Welding & Fabrication Shop →

🎯 30×24

Boat & Trailer Storage

30×24 boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏡 30×24

Detached Home Gym

30×24 detached home gym configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Detached Home Gym →

🏢 30×24

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay →

🏛️ 30×24

Community or Church Storage

30×24 community or church storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,600Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Community or Church Storage →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Three-Car Detached Garage questions, answered.

How much does a 30×24 three-car detached garage cost?

A 30×24 three-car detached garage from Steel and Stud starts at $10,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $222/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×24 three-car detached garage price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud three-car detached garage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×24 three-car detached garage?

Almost always for 720+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud three-car detached garage different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×24 three-car detached garage need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×24 three-car detached garage delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×24 three-car detached garage without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $222/month on a 30×24 three-car detached garage.

What warranty comes with the 30×24 three-car detached garage?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×24 three-car detached garage in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does a 30×24 three-car detached garage add resale value to my home?

An enclosed 30×24 three-car detached garage typically adds $5,760–$8,640 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.

Ready to build?

Your Three-Car Detached Garage quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$10,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Forest green steel garage with tan roll-up door against a wooded hillside

30×24 Three-Car Detached Garage

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$10,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Matte black metal workshop with single roll-up door against snow-capped autumn mountains

30×24 Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×24 Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay | Steel and Stud, From $10,650

12

30×24 Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$12,150$10,650SAVE $1,500
or $222/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×24Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×24 Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay, built for daily backyard use.

Our 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay fits 30-foot widths and 24-foot lengths to give you a finished daily-use building without contractor pricing. Tradespeople and weekend mechanics split the 30-foot width into.

You’re viewing:Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay·Size30×24·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$10,650$12,150Save $1,500
or as low as $222/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×24
30×24
this size
$10,650
30×25
longer
$9,500
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 720 sq ft enclosed
  • 12 GA Upgrade
  • 2 Windows
  • Walk-In Door
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X24-TWO-CAR-GARAGE-PBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your two-bay garage.

30 feet wide × 24 feet long. Two 9-ft doors, walk-in side entry. Our 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay fits 30-foot widths and 24-foot lengths to give you a finished daily-use building without contractor pricing.

Vehicle bay 1Vehicle bay 2Workbench / tools30′ × 24′ · 720 sq ft · two-bay garage

Vehicle bay 1 · Vehicle bay 2 · Workbench / tools

Vehicle bay 1 at the front, vehicle bay 2 in the middle, workbench / tools at the rear. Capacity: 3 vehicles + small workshop. Tradespeople and weekend mechanics split the 30-foot width into two 10-foot vehicle bays and one 10-foot workshop corner.

💡 Pro tip:Workbench-Ready. Size affords: lift rough-in, air compressor, shop sink.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×24 Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
720 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×24 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay spec sheet.

Width30′
Length24′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space720 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay.

DAILY USEEveryday two-car garage plus workshop bay
Everyday two-car garage plus workshop bay
720 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a two-car garage plus workshop bay.
STORAGE OVERFLOWtwo-car garage plus workshop bay + seasonal storage
two-car garage plus workshop bay + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×24 Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay, what makes it different.

720sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$222/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $222/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×24?

720 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 24′ footprint with 720 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $5,760–$8,640 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×24 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×24 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×24 Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×24 Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×25×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$3,240+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay also viewed:

🏡 30×24

Three-Car Detached Garage

30×24 three-car detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Three-Car Detached Garage →

🎯 30×24

RV Cover With Side Storage

30×24 rv cover with side storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover With Side Storage →

🌾 30×24

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

30×24 hobby farm equipment shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobby Farm Equipment Shed →

🏢 30×24

Small Business Shop

30×24 small business shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Business Shop →

🏡 30×24

Man Cave or She Shed

30×24 man cave or she shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Man Cave or She Shed →

🌾 30×24

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter →

🏭 30×24

Welding & Fabrication Shop

30×24 welding & fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,900Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Welding & Fabrication Shop →

🎯 30×24

Boat & Trailer Storage

30×24 boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏡 30×24

Detached Home Gym

30×24 detached home gym configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Detached Home Gym →

🏢 30×24

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay →

🏛️ 30×24

Community or Church Storage

30×24 community or church storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,600Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Community or Church Storage →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay questions, answered.

How much does a 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay cost?

A 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay from Steel and Stud starts at $10,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $222/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud two-car garage plus workshop bay ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay?

Almost always for 720+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud two-car garage plus workshop bay different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $222/month on a 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay.

What warranty comes with the 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does a 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay add resale value to my home?

An enclosed 30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay typically adds $5,760–$8,640 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.

Ready to build?

Your Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$10,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Matte black metal workshop with single roll-up door against snow-capped autumn mountains

30×24 Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$10,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Tall gable metal building kit in ivory with large brown roll-up door and side entry

30×24 RV Cover With Side Storage

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×24 RV Cover With Side Storage | Steel and Stud, From $10,650

12

30×24 RV Cover With Side Storage
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$12,150$10,650SAVE $1,500
or $222/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×24RV Cover With Side Storage

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×24 RV Cover With Side Storage, built for hobby and recreational use.

Our 30×24 rv cover with side storage fits 30-foot widths and 24-foot lengths to give you a comfortable hobby retreat with sidewall room to spare. RV owners with a Class C or 25-foot travel trailer use the 30×24 to park.

You’re viewing:RV Cover With Side Storage·Size30×24·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$10,650$12,150Save $1,500
or as low as $222/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×24
30×24
this size
$10,650
30×25
longer
$9,500
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 720 sq ft enclosed
  • 12′ Legs
  • 12×12 Roll-Up
  • Vertical Roof
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X24-RV-COVER-SIDE-STBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your RV-cover layout.

30 feet wide × 24 feet long. 14-ft sidewalls fit slide-outs deployed. Our 30×24 rv cover with side storage fits 30-foot widths and 24-foot lengths to give you a comfortable hobby retreat with sidewall room to spare.

RV BAYDaily driverHookup / pre-wire30′ × 24′ · 720 sq ft · RV-cover layout

RV bay · Daily driver · Hookup / pre-wire

RV bay at the front, daily driver in the middle, hookup / pre-wire at the rear. Capacity: 1 Class A up to 20ft + 1 daily driver. RV owners with a Class C or 25-foot travel trailer use the 30×24 to park the rig down one side and keep a 12-foot bay for a car, kayaks, or yard equipment.

💡 Pro tip:RV-Height Clearance. Size affords: 50A hookup, sewer dump, overhead lighting.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×24 RV Cover With Side Storage in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your RV Cover With Side Storage.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
720 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×24 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

RV Cover With Side Storage spec sheet.

Width30′
Length24′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space720 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use RV Cover With Side Storage.

DAILY USEEveryday rv cover with side storage
Everyday rv cover with side storage
720 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a rv cover with side storage.
STORAGE OVERFLOWrv cover with side storage + seasonal storage
rv cover with side storage + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×24 RV Cover With Side Storage, what makes it different.

720sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$222/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×24 rv cover with side storage is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $222/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×24?

720 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 24′ footprint with 720 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $5,760–$8,640 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from RV Cover With Side Storage shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×24 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×24 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×24 RV Cover With Side Storage buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×24 RV Cover With Side Storage

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your RV Cover With Side Storage · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×25×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$3,240+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose RV Cover With Side Storage also viewed:

🏡 30×24

Three-Car Detached Garage

30×24 three-car detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Three-Car Detached Garage →

🏡 30×24

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay →

🌾 30×24

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

30×24 hobby farm equipment shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobby Farm Equipment Shed →

🏢 30×24

Small Business Shop

30×24 small business shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Business Shop →

🏡 30×24

Man Cave or She Shed

30×24 man cave or she shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Man Cave or She Shed →

🌾 30×24

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter →

🏭 30×24

Welding & Fabrication Shop

30×24 welding & fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,900Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Welding & Fabrication Shop →

🎯 30×24

Boat & Trailer Storage

30×24 boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏡 30×24

Detached Home Gym

30×24 detached home gym configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Detached Home Gym →

🏢 30×24

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay →

🏛️ 30×24

Community or Church Storage

30×24 community or church storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,600Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Community or Church Storage →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

RV Cover With Side Storage questions, answered.

How much does a 30×24 rv cover with side storage cost?

A 30×24 rv cover with side storage from Steel and Stud starts at $10,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $222/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×24 rv cover with side storage price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud rv cover with side storage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×24 rv cover with side storage?

Almost always for 720+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud rv cover with side storage different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×24 rv cover with side storage need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×24 rv cover with side storage delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×24 rv cover with side storage without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $222/month on a 30×24 rv cover with side storage.

What warranty comes with the 30×24 rv cover with side storage?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×24 rv cover with side storage in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Can I insulate the 30×24 rv cover with side storage for year-round use?

Yes, Steel and Stud offers R-13 wall + R-19 ceiling insulation packages, and the interior is drywall-ready. Most owners finish a rv cover with side storage to a livable retreat in 2–3 weekends. Add a mini-split HVAC at checkout for full four-season comfort.

Ready to build?

Your RV Cover With Side Storage quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$10,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Tall gable metal building kit in ivory with large brown roll-up door and side entry

30×24 RV Cover With Side Storage

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$10,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Tan steel garage with black sectional doors, stone base, and tall side equipment door

30×24 Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×24 Hobby Farm Equipment Shed | Steel and Stud, From $11,300

12

30×24 Hobby Farm Equipment Shed
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$12,900$11,300SAVE $1,600
or $235/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×24Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×24 Hobby Farm Equipment Shed, built for farm and ranch demands.

Built for farm and ranch operations, this 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed packs 720 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Hobby farmers park a compact tractor, a UTV, a brush hog, and a small implement trailer under one.

You’re viewing:Hobby Farm Equipment Shed·Size30×24·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$11,300$12,900Save $1,600
or as low as $235/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×24
30×24
this size
$11,300
30×25
longer
$10,150
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 720 sq ft enclosed
  • Open Front
  • 12 GA Frame
  • Ground Anchors
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X24-HOBBY-FARM-EQUIPBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your equipment-barn layout.

30 feet wide × 24 feet long. Built for farm and ranch operations, this 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed packs 720 sq ft into a code-compliant shell.

Tractor bayImplement bayTool rack30′ × 24′ · 720 sq ft · equipment-barn layout

Tractor bay · Implement bay · Tool rack

Tractor bay at the front, implement bay in the middle, tool rack at the rear. Hobby farmers park a compact tractor, a UTV, a brush hog, and a small implement trailer under one roof.

💡 Pro tip:Mud-Rated Floor.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×24 Hobby Farm Equipment Shed in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Hobby Farm Equipment Shed.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
720 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×24 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed spec sheet.

Width30′
Length24′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space720 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Hobby Farm Equipment Shed.

DAILY USEEveryday hobby farm equipment shed
Everyday hobby farm equipment shed
720 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a hobby farm equipment shed.
STORAGE OVERFLOWhobby farm equipment shed + seasonal storage
hobby farm equipment shed + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×24 Hobby Farm Equipment Shed, what makes it different.

720sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$235/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $235/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×24?

720 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 24′ footprint with 720 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $5,760–$8,640 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Hobby Farm Equipment Shed shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×24 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×24 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×24 Hobby Farm Equipment Shed buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×24 Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Hobby Farm Equipment Shed · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×25×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$3,240+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Hobby Farm Equipment Shed also viewed:

🏡 30×24

Three-Car Detached Garage

30×24 three-car detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Three-Car Detached Garage →

🏡 30×24

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay →

🎯 30×24

RV Cover With Side Storage

30×24 rv cover with side storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover With Side Storage →

🏢 30×24

Small Business Shop

30×24 small business shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Business Shop →

🏡 30×24

Man Cave or She Shed

30×24 man cave or she shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Man Cave or She Shed →

🌾 30×24

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter →

🏭 30×24

Welding & Fabrication Shop

30×24 welding & fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,900Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Welding & Fabrication Shop →

🎯 30×24

Boat & Trailer Storage

30×24 boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏡 30×24

Detached Home Gym

30×24 detached home gym configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Detached Home Gym →

🏢 30×24

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay →

🏛️ 30×24

Community or Church Storage

30×24 community or church storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,600Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Community or Church Storage →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed questions, answered.

How much does a 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed cost?

A 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed from Steel and Stud starts at $11,300 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $235/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud hobby farm equipment shed ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed?

Almost always for 720+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud hobby farm equipment shed different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $235/month on a 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed.

What warranty comes with the 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×24 hobby farm equipment shed stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?

The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.

Ready to build?

Your Hobby Farm Equipment Shed quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$11,300.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Tan steel garage with black sectional doors, stone base, and tall side equipment door

30×24 Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$11,300.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Barn red prefab metal building storefront with large windows and covered side entry

30×24 Small Business Shop

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×24 Small Business Shop | Steel and Stud, From $12,500

12

30×24 Small Business Shop
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$14,250$12,500SAVE $1,750
or $260/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×24Small Business Shop

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×24 Small Business Shop, engineered for code-compliant business use.

30×24 delivers 720 sq ft of code-compliant small business shop space. Add a 30×24 roll-up for the work truck, a walk-in door, two storefront windows, and R-19 insulation. Certified engineering is available where county.

You’re viewing:Small Business Shop·Size30×24·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$12,500$14,250Save $1,750
or as low as $260/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×24
30×24
this size
$12,500
30×25
longer
$11,350
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 720 sq ft enclosed
  • R-19 Insulation
  • Storefront Windows
  • Certified Build
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X24-SMALL-BUSINESS-SBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your small business shop layout.

30 feet wide × 24 feet long. 30×24 delivers 720 sq ft of code-compliant small business shop space.

Pickup BayWORKSHOP30′ × 24′ · 720 sq ft · small business shop layout

Small Business Shop layout.

30×24 delivers 720 sq ft of code-compliant small business shop space. Add a 30×24 roll-up for the work truck, a walk-in door, two storefront windows, and R-19 insulation. Certified engineering is available where county code requires it for commercial use.

💡 Pro tip:Commercial-Permit Ready.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×24 Small Business Shop in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Small Business Shop.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
720 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×24 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Small Business Shop spec sheet.

Width30′
Length24′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space720 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Small Business Shop.

DAILY USEEveryday small business shop
Everyday small business shop
720 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a small business shop.
STORAGE OVERFLOWsmall business shop + seasonal storage
small business shop + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×24 Small Business Shop, what makes it different.

720sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$260/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×24 small business shop is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $260/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×24?

720 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 24′ footprint with 720 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $5,760–$8,640 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Small Business Shop shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×24 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×24 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×24 Small Business Shop buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×24 Small Business Shop

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Small Business Shop · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×25×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$3,240+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Small Business Shop also viewed:

🏡 30×24

Three-Car Detached Garage

30×24 three-car detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Three-Car Detached Garage →

🏡 30×24

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay →

🎯 30×24

RV Cover With Side Storage

30×24 rv cover with side storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover With Side Storage →

🌾 30×24

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

30×24 hobby farm equipment shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobby Farm Equipment Shed →

🏡 30×24

Man Cave or She Shed

30×24 man cave or she shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Man Cave or She Shed →

🌾 30×24

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter →

🏭 30×24

Welding & Fabrication Shop

30×24 welding & fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,900Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Welding & Fabrication Shop →

🎯 30×24

Boat & Trailer Storage

30×24 boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏡 30×24

Detached Home Gym

30×24 detached home gym configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Detached Home Gym →

🏢 30×24

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay →

🏛️ 30×24

Community or Church Storage

30×24 community or church storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,600Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Community or Church Storage →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Small Business Shop questions, answered.

How much does a 30×24 small business shop cost?

A 30×24 small business shop from Steel and Stud starts at $12,500 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $260/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×24 small business shop price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud small business shop ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×24 small business shop?

Almost always for 720+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud small business shop different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×24 small business shop need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×24 small business shop delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×24 small business shop without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $260/month on a 30×24 small business shop.

What warranty comes with the 30×24 small business shop?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×24 small business shop in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does the 30×24 small business shop meet IBC commercial code?

Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.

Ready to build?

Your Small Business Shop quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$12,500.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Barn red prefab metal building storefront with large windows and covered side entry

30×24 Small Business Shop

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$12,500.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Barn red steel garage with white roll-up door and pickup truck parked outside

30×24 Man Cave or She Shed

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×24 Man Cave or She Shed | Steel and Stud, From $10,650

12

30×24 Man Cave or She Shed
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$12,150$10,650SAVE $1,500
or $222/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×24Man Cave or She Shed

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×24 Man Cave or She Shed, built for daily backyard use.

Looking for a 30×24 man cave or she shed? At 720 sq ft, this footprint suits homeowners adding garage, workshop, or hobby space. 720 square feet is more than enough for a finished hangout, pool table, bar, big-screen.

You’re viewing:Man Cave or She Shed·Size30×24·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$10,650$12,150Save $1,500
or as low as $222/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×24
30×24
this size
$10,650
30×25
longer
$9,500
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 720 sq ft enclosed
  • Wainscoting
  • R-13 Insulation
  • 3 Windows
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X24-MAN-CAVE-SHE-SHEBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your finished retreat layout.

30 feet wide × 24 feet long. Looking for a 30×24 man cave or she shed? At 720 sq ft, this footprint suits homeowners adding garage, workshop, or hobby space.

Main loungeWet bar / Kitch.Bath / Storage30′ × 24′ · 720 sq ft · finished retreat layout

Main lounge · Wet bar / Kitch. · Bath / Storage

Main lounge at the front, wet bar / kitch. in the middle, bath / storage at the rear. 720 square feet is more than enough for a finished hangout, pool table, bar, big-screen wall, plus a 10-foot bay for the car.

💡 Pro tip:Finished-Interior Ready.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×24 Man Cave or She Shed in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Man Cave or She Shed.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
720 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×24 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Man Cave or She Shed spec sheet.

Width30′
Length24′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space720 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Man Cave or She Shed.

DAILY USEEveryday man cave or she shed
Everyday man cave or she shed
720 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a man cave or she shed.
STORAGE OVERFLOWman cave or she shed + seasonal storage
man cave or she shed + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×24 Man Cave or She Shed, what makes it different.

720sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$222/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×24 man cave or she shed is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $222/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×24?

720 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 24′ footprint with 720 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $5,760–$8,640 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Man Cave or She Shed shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×24 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×24 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×24 Man Cave or She Shed buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×24 Man Cave or She Shed

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Man Cave or She Shed · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×25×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$3,240+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Man Cave or She Shed also viewed:

🏡 30×24

Three-Car Detached Garage

30×24 three-car detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Three-Car Detached Garage →

🏡 30×24

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay →

🎯 30×24

RV Cover With Side Storage

30×24 rv cover with side storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover With Side Storage →

🌾 30×24

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

30×24 hobby farm equipment shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobby Farm Equipment Shed →

🏢 30×24

Small Business Shop

30×24 small business shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Business Shop →

🌾 30×24

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter →

🏭 30×24

Welding & Fabrication Shop

30×24 welding & fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,900Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Welding & Fabrication Shop →

🎯 30×24

Boat & Trailer Storage

30×24 boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏡 30×24

Detached Home Gym

30×24 detached home gym configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Detached Home Gym →

🏢 30×24

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay →

🏛️ 30×24

Community or Church Storage

30×24 community or church storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,600Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Community or Church Storage →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Man Cave or She Shed questions, answered.

How much does a 30×24 man cave or she shed cost?

A 30×24 man cave or she shed from Steel and Stud starts at $10,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $222/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×24 man cave or she shed price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud man cave or she shed ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×24 man cave or she shed?

Almost always for 720+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud man cave or she shed different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×24 man cave or she shed need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×24 man cave or she shed delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×24 man cave or she shed without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $222/month on a 30×24 man cave or she shed.

What warranty comes with the 30×24 man cave or she shed?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×24 man cave or she shed in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does a 30×24 man cave or she shed add resale value to my home?

An enclosed 30×24 man cave or she shed typically adds $5,760–$8,640 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.

Ready to build?

Your Man Cave or She Shed quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$10,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Barn red steel garage with white roll-up door and pickup truck parked outside

30×24 Man Cave or She Shed

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$10,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Tan metal building styled as a horse barn with dutch door, cupola, and goat in pasture

30×24 Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×24 Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter | Steel and Stud, From $11,300

12

30×24 Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$12,900$11,300SAVE $1,600
or $235/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×24Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×24 Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter, built for farm and ranch demands.

30×24 delivers 720 sq ft of rugged small horse barn or animal shelter space. Two stalls plus a tack room fit cleanly inside a 30×24 horse barn, with a sliding barn door on the gable for tractor access. Rural property.

You’re viewing:Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter·Size30×24·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$11,300$12,900Save $1,600
or as low as $235/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×24
30×24
this size
$11,300
30×25
longer
$10,150
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 720 sq ft enclosed
  • Sliding Barn Door
  • Boxed Eave Roof
  • Ridge Vent
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X24-SMALL-HORSE-BARNBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your shedrow horse barn.

30 feet wide × 24 feet long. Center-aisle layout with cross-ties. 30×24 delivers 720 sq ft of rugged small horse barn or animal shelter space.

1 stalls10-FT CENTER AISLETack + Feed room30′ × 24′ · 720 sq ft · shedrow horse barn

1 stalls · 10-ft center aisle · Tack + Feed room

1 stalls at the front, 10-ft center aisle in the middle, tack + feed room at the rear. Capacity: 1 horses + tack + feed. Two stalls plus a tack room fit cleanly inside a 30×24 horse barn, with a sliding barn door on the gable for tractor access.

💡 Pro tip:2-Stall Layout. Size affords: dutch doors per stall, wash bay rough-in, fly system.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×24 Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
720 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×24 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter spec sheet.

Width30′
Length24′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space720 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter.

DAILY USEEveryday small horse barn or animal shelter
Everyday small horse barn or animal shelter
720 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a small horse barn or animal shelter.
STORAGE OVERFLOWsmall horse barn or animal shelter + seasonal storage
small horse barn or animal shelter + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×24 Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter, what makes it different.

720sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$235/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $235/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×24?

720 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 24′ footprint with 720 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $5,760–$8,640 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×24 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×24 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×24 Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×24 Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×25×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$3,240+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter also viewed:

🏡 30×24

Three-Car Detached Garage

30×24 three-car detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Three-Car Detached Garage →

🏡 30×24

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay →

🎯 30×24

RV Cover With Side Storage

30×24 rv cover with side storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover With Side Storage →

🌾 30×24

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

30×24 hobby farm equipment shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobby Farm Equipment Shed →

🏢 30×24

Small Business Shop

30×24 small business shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Business Shop →

🏡 30×24

Man Cave or She Shed

30×24 man cave or she shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Man Cave or She Shed →

🏭 30×24

Welding & Fabrication Shop

30×24 welding & fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,900Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Welding & Fabrication Shop →

🎯 30×24

Boat & Trailer Storage

30×24 boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏡 30×24

Detached Home Gym

30×24 detached home gym configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Detached Home Gym →

🏢 30×24

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay →

🏛️ 30×24

Community or Church Storage

30×24 community or church storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,600Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Community or Church Storage →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter questions, answered.

How much does a 30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter cost?

A 30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter from Steel and Stud starts at $11,300 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $235/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud small horse barn or animal shelter ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter?

Almost always for 720+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud small horse barn or animal shelter different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $235/month on a 30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter.

What warranty comes with the 30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?

The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.

Ready to build?

Your Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$11,300.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Tan metal building styled as a horse barn with dutch door, cupola, and goat in pasture

30×24 Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$11,300.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Steel structure interior fitted as a contractor shop with lumber racks, workbench, and power tools

30×24 Welding & Fabrication Shop

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×24 Welding & Fabrication Shop | Steel and Stud, From $12,900

12

30×24 Welding & Fabrication Shop
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$14,700$12,900SAVE $1,800
or $269/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×24Welding & Fabrication Shop

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×24 Welding & Fabrication Shop, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.

Looking for a 30×24 welding & fabrication shop? At 720 sq ft, this footprint suits fabrication, heavy machinery, or warehousing. Welders and fabricators need 12-ft to 14-ft legs to swing long stock and run a small.

You’re viewing:Welding & Fabrication Shop·Size30×24·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$12,900$14,700Save $1,800
or as low as $269/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×24
30×24
this size
$12,900
30×25
longer
$11,750
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 720 sq ft enclosed
  • 14′ Legs
  • 12 GA Frame
  • Drive-Through
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X24-WELDING-FABRICATBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your workshop layout.

30 feet wide × 24 feet long. Side-load + walk-in, dust-collection ready. Looking for a 30×24 welding & fabrication shop? At 720 sq ft, this footprint suits fabrication, heavy machinery, or warehousing.

Workbench wallTABLE SAW / CENTERLumber / Material rack30′ × 24′ · 720 sq ft · workshop layout

Workbench wall · Table saw / Center · Lumber / Material rack

Workbench wall at the front, table saw / center in the middle, lumber / material rack at the rear. Capacity: 1-person serious shop. Welders and fabricators need 12-ft to 14-ft legs to swing long stock and run a small overhead hoist.

💡 Pro tip:Hoist-Rated Framing. Size affords: dust collection, 220V subpanel, shop sink.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×24 Welding & Fabrication Shop in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Welding & Fabrication Shop.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
720 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×24 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Welding & Fabrication Shop spec sheet.

Width30′
Length24′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space720 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Welding & Fabrication Shop.

DAILY USEEveryday welding & fabrication shop
Everyday welding & fabrication shop
720 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a welding & fabrication shop.
STORAGE OVERFLOWwelding & fabrication shop + seasonal storage
welding & fabrication shop + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×24 Welding & Fabrication Shop, what makes it different.

720sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$269/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×24 welding & fabrication shop is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $269/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×24?

720 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 24′ footprint with 720 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $5,760–$8,640 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Welding & Fabrication Shop shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×24 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×24 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×24 Welding & Fabrication Shop buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×24 Welding & Fabrication Shop

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Welding & Fabrication Shop · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×25×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$3,240+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Welding & Fabrication Shop also viewed:

🏡 30×24

Three-Car Detached Garage

30×24 three-car detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Three-Car Detached Garage →

🏡 30×24

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay →

🎯 30×24

RV Cover With Side Storage

30×24 rv cover with side storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover With Side Storage →

🌾 30×24

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

30×24 hobby farm equipment shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobby Farm Equipment Shed →

🏢 30×24

Small Business Shop

30×24 small business shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Business Shop →

🏡 30×24

Man Cave or She Shed

30×24 man cave or she shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Man Cave or She Shed →

🌾 30×24

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter →

🎯 30×24

Boat & Trailer Storage

30×24 boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏡 30×24

Detached Home Gym

30×24 detached home gym configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Detached Home Gym →

🏢 30×24

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay →

🏛️ 30×24

Community or Church Storage

30×24 community or church storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,600Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Community or Church Storage →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Welding & Fabrication Shop questions, answered.

How much does a 30×24 welding & fabrication shop cost?

A 30×24 welding & fabrication shop from Steel and Stud starts at $12,900 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $269/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×24 welding & fabrication shop price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud welding & fabrication shop ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×24 welding & fabrication shop?

Almost always for 720+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud welding & fabrication shop different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×24 welding & fabrication shop need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×24 welding & fabrication shop delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×24 welding & fabrication shop without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $269/month on a 30×24 welding & fabrication shop.

What warranty comes with the 30×24 welding & fabrication shop?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×24 welding & fabrication shop in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×24 welding & fabrication shop handle heavy equipment and forklifts?

Standard 30×24 welding & fabrication shop ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.

Ready to build?

Your Welding & Fabrication Shop quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$12,900.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Steel structure interior fitted as a contractor shop with lumber racks, workbench, and power tools

30×24 Welding & Fabrication Shop

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$12,900.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Tan metal building with brown trim, open roll-up bay and bass boat on trailer

30×24 Boat & Trailer Storage

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×24 Boat & Trailer Storage | Steel and Stud, From $10,650

12

30×24 Boat & Trailer Storage
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$12,150$10,650SAVE $1,500
or $222/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×24Boat & Trailer Storage

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×24 Boat & Trailer Storage, built for hobby and recreational use.

Looking for a 30×24 boat & trailer storage? At 720 sq ft, this footprint suits home gyms, hunting cabins, or backyard retreats. RV owners and weekend boaters store a 22- to 24-foot boat plus the tow vehicle inside the.

You’re viewing:Boat & Trailer Storage·Size30×24·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$10,650$12,150Save $1,500
or as low as $222/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×24
30×24
this size
$10,650
30×25
longer
$9,500
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 720 sq ft enclosed
  • 10×10 Roll-Up
  • 10′ Legs
  • Walk-In Door
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X24-BOAT-TRAILER-STOBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your boat-storage layout.

30 feet wide × 24 feet long. Looking for a 30×24 boat & trailer storage? At 720 sq ft, this footprint suits home gyms, hunting cabins, or backyard retreats.

Boat + trailerDaily driverOutboard / rinse30′ × 24′ · 720 sq ft · boat-storage layout

Boat + trailer · Daily driver · Outboard / rinse

Boat + trailer at the front, daily driver in the middle, outboard / rinse at the rear. RV owners and weekend boaters store a 22- to 24-foot boat plus the tow vehicle inside the same 720 sq ft footprint.

💡 Pro tip:Straight-Back-In Layout.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×24 Boat & Trailer Storage in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Boat & Trailer Storage.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
720 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×24 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Boat & Trailer Storage spec sheet.

Width30′
Length24′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space720 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Boat & Trailer Storage.

DAILY USEEveryday boat & trailer storage
Everyday boat & trailer storage
720 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a boat & trailer storage.
STORAGE OVERFLOWboat & trailer storage + seasonal storage
boat & trailer storage + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×24 Boat & Trailer Storage, what makes it different.

720sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$222/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×24 boat & trailer storage is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $222/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×24?

720 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 24′ footprint with 720 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $5,760–$8,640 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Boat & Trailer Storage shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×24 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×24 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×24 Boat & Trailer Storage buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×24 Boat & Trailer Storage

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Boat & Trailer Storage · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×25×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$3,240+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Boat & Trailer Storage also viewed:

🏡 30×24

Three-Car Detached Garage

30×24 three-car detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Three-Car Detached Garage →

🏡 30×24

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay →

🎯 30×24

RV Cover With Side Storage

30×24 rv cover with side storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover With Side Storage →

🌾 30×24

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

30×24 hobby farm equipment shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobby Farm Equipment Shed →

🏢 30×24

Small Business Shop

30×24 small business shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Business Shop →

🏡 30×24

Man Cave or She Shed

30×24 man cave or she shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Man Cave or She Shed →

🌾 30×24

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter →

🏭 30×24

Welding & Fabrication Shop

30×24 welding & fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,900Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Welding & Fabrication Shop →

🏡 30×24

Detached Home Gym

30×24 detached home gym configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Detached Home Gym →

🏢 30×24

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay →

🏛️ 30×24

Community or Church Storage

30×24 community or church storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,600Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Community or Church Storage →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Boat & Trailer Storage questions, answered.

How much does a 30×24 boat & trailer storage cost?

A 30×24 boat & trailer storage from Steel and Stud starts at $10,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $222/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×24 boat & trailer storage price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud boat & trailer storage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×24 boat & trailer storage?

Almost always for 720+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud boat & trailer storage different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×24 boat & trailer storage need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×24 boat & trailer storage delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×24 boat & trailer storage without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $222/month on a 30×24 boat & trailer storage.

What warranty comes with the 30×24 boat & trailer storage?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×24 boat & trailer storage in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Can I insulate the 30×24 boat & trailer storage for year-round use?

Yes, Steel and Stud offers R-13 wall + R-19 ceiling insulation packages, and the interior is drywall-ready. Most owners finish a boat & trailer storage to a livable retreat in 2–3 weekends. Add a mini-split HVAC at checkout for full four-season comfort.

Ready to build?

Your Boat & Trailer Storage quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$10,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Tan metal building with brown trim, open roll-up bay and bass boat on trailer

30×24 Boat & Trailer Storage

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$10,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Hip roof prefab metal building in warm wood brown with glass panels and exercise bike

30×24 Detached Home Gym

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×24 Detached Home Gym | Steel and Stud, From $10,650

12

30×24 Detached Home Gym
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$12,150$10,650SAVE $1,500
or $222/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×24Detached Home Gym

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×24 Detached Home Gym, built for daily backyard use.

Looking for a 30×24 detached home gym? At 720 sq ft, this footprint suits homeowners adding garage, workshop, or hobby space. 720 sq ft fits a full rack, a platform, cardio equipment, mirrors and rubber flooring with.

You’re viewing:Detached Home Gym·Size30×24·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$10,650$12,150Save $1,500
or as low as $222/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×24
30×24
this size
$10,650
30×25
longer
$9,500
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 720 sq ft enclosed
  • R-19 Insulation
  • 4 Windows
  • Clear Span
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X24-DETACHED-HOME-GYBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your home-gym layout.

30 feet wide × 24 feet long. Looking for a 30×24 detached home gym? At 720 sq ft, this footprint suits homeowners adding garage, workshop, or hobby space.

Cardio zoneWeight rackStretch / Bench30′ × 24′ · 720 sq ft · home-gym layout

Cardio zone · Weight rack · Stretch / Bench

Cardio zone at the front, weight rack in the middle, stretch / bench at the rear. 720 sq ft fits a full rack, a platform, cardio equipment, mirrors and rubber flooring with room to actually train.

💡 Pro tip:Platform-Ready Span.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×24 Detached Home Gym in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Detached Home Gym.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
720 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×24 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Detached Home Gym spec sheet.

Width30′
Length24′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space720 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Detached Home Gym.

DAILY USEEveryday detached home gym
Everyday detached home gym
720 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a detached home gym.
STORAGE OVERFLOWdetached home gym + seasonal storage
detached home gym + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×24 Detached Home Gym, what makes it different.

720sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$222/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×24 detached home gym is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $222/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×24?

720 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 24′ footprint with 720 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $5,760–$8,640 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Detached Home Gym shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×24 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×24 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×24 Detached Home Gym buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×24 Detached Home Gym

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Detached Home Gym · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×25×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$3,240+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Detached Home Gym also viewed:

🏡 30×24

Three-Car Detached Garage

30×24 three-car detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Three-Car Detached Garage →

🏡 30×24

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay →

🎯 30×24

RV Cover With Side Storage

30×24 rv cover with side storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover With Side Storage →

🌾 30×24

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

30×24 hobby farm equipment shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobby Farm Equipment Shed →

🏢 30×24

Small Business Shop

30×24 small business shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Business Shop →

🏡 30×24

Man Cave or She Shed

30×24 man cave or she shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Man Cave or She Shed →

🌾 30×24

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter →

🏭 30×24

Welding & Fabrication Shop

30×24 welding & fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,900Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Welding & Fabrication Shop →

🎯 30×24

Boat & Trailer Storage

30×24 boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏢 30×24

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay →

🏛️ 30×24

Community or Church Storage

30×24 community or church storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,600Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Community or Church Storage →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Detached Home Gym questions, answered.

How much does a 30×24 detached home gym cost?

A 30×24 detached home gym from Steel and Stud starts at $10,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $222/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×24 detached home gym price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud detached home gym ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×24 detached home gym?

Almost always for 720+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud detached home gym different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×24 detached home gym need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×24 detached home gym delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×24 detached home gym without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $222/month on a 30×24 detached home gym.

What warranty comes with the 30×24 detached home gym?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×24 detached home gym in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does a 30×24 detached home gym add resale value to my home?

An enclosed 30×24 detached home gym typically adds $5,760–$8,640 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.

Ready to build?

Your Detached Home Gym quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$10,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Hip roof prefab metal building in warm wood brown with glass panels and exercise bike

30×24 Detached Home Gym

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$10,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Forest green commercial metal building fabrication shop with welder, forklift, and steel inventory

30×24 Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×24 Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay | Steel and Stud, From $12,500

12

30×24 Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$14,250$12,500SAVE $1,750
or $260/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×24Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×24 Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay, engineered for code-compliant business use.

30×24 delivers 720 sq ft of code-compliant auto detailing or fleet bay space. Detailers and small fleet operators run a drive-through wash-and-prep bay inside the 30×24. Spec two 30×24 roll-ups on opposite gables for.

You’re viewing:Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay·Size30×24·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$12,500$14,250Save $1,750
or as low as $260/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×24
30×24
this size
$12,500
30×25
longer
$11,350
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 720 sq ft enclosed
  • Drive-Through Doors
  • Floor Drain Framing
  • 14′ Legs
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X24-AUTO-DETAILING-FBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your fleet-garage layout.

30 feet wide × 24 feet long. 30×24 delivers 720 sq ft of code-compliant auto detailing or fleet bay space.

Service vehicle 1Service vehicle 2TOOLS / PARTS30′ × 24′ · 720 sq ft · fleet-garage layout

Service vehicle 1 · Service vehicle 2 · Tools / parts

Service vehicle 1 at the front, service vehicle 2 in the middle, tools / parts at the rear. Detailers and small fleet operators run a drive-through wash-and-prep bay inside the 30×24.

💡 Pro tip:Wash-Bay Ready.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×24 Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
720 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×24 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay spec sheet.

Width30′
Length24′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space720 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay.

DAILY USEEveryday auto detailing or fleet bay
Everyday auto detailing or fleet bay
720 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a auto detailing or fleet bay.
STORAGE OVERFLOWauto detailing or fleet bay + seasonal storage
auto detailing or fleet bay + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×24 Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay, what makes it different.

720sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$260/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $260/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×24?

720 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 24′ footprint with 720 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $5,760–$8,640 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×24 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×24 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×24 Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×24 Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×25×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$3,240+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay also viewed:

🏡 30×24

Three-Car Detached Garage

30×24 three-car detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Three-Car Detached Garage →

🏡 30×24

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay →

🎯 30×24

RV Cover With Side Storage

30×24 rv cover with side storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover With Side Storage →

🌾 30×24

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

30×24 hobby farm equipment shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobby Farm Equipment Shed →

🏢 30×24

Small Business Shop

30×24 small business shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Business Shop →

🏡 30×24

Man Cave or She Shed

30×24 man cave or she shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Man Cave or She Shed →

🌾 30×24

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter →

🏭 30×24

Welding & Fabrication Shop

30×24 welding & fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,900Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Welding & Fabrication Shop →

🎯 30×24

Boat & Trailer Storage

30×24 boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏡 30×24

Detached Home Gym

30×24 detached home gym configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Detached Home Gym →

🏛️ 30×24

Community or Church Storage

30×24 community or church storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,600Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Community or Church Storage →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay questions, answered.

How much does a 30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay cost?

A 30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay from Steel and Stud starts at $12,500 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $260/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud auto detailing or fleet bay ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay?

Almost always for 720+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud auto detailing or fleet bay different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $260/month on a 30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay.

What warranty comes with the 30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does the 30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay meet IBC commercial code?

Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.

Ready to build?

Your Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$12,500.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Forest green commercial metal building fabrication shop with welder, forklift, and steel inventory

30×24 Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$12,500.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
White steel structure event venue with black-framed glass entry and fountains in a modern courtyard

30×24 Community or Church Storage

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×24 Community or Church Storage | Steel and Stud, From $12,600

12

30×24 Community or Church Storage
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$14,350$12,600SAVE $1,750
or $263/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×24Community or Church Storage

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×24 Community or Church Storage, engineered to code for assembly use.

Looking for a 30×24 community or church storage? At 720 sq ft, this footprint suits public assembly, community use, or worship space. Churches, schools and HOAs use a 30×24 prefab building to store tables, chairs.

You’re viewing:Community or Church Storage·Size30×24·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$12,600$14,350Save $1,750
or as low as $263/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×24
30×24
this size
$12,600
30×25
longer
$11,450
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 720 sq ft enclosed
  • Keypad Lock
  • Color-Match Trim
  • Stamped Drawings
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X24-COMMUNITY-CHURCHBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your chapel layout.

30 feet wide × 24 feet long. Intimate sanctuary, single-aisle layout. Looking for a 30×24 community or church storage? At 720 sq ft, this footprint suits public assembly, community use, or worship space.

Altar / pulpitPew areaFOYER30′ × 24′ · 720 sq ft · chapel layout

Altar / pulpit · Pew area · Foyer

Altar / pulpit at the front, pew area in the middle, foyer at the rear. Capacity: seats ~72. Churches, schools and HOAs use a 30×24 prefab building to store tables, chairs, holiday decor, mowers and event equipment in one secured space.

💡 Pro tip:HOA-Friendly Look. Size affords: choir stand, narthex.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×24 Community or Church Storage in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Community or Church Storage.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
720 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×24 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Community or Church Storage spec sheet.

Width30′
Length24′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space720 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Community or Church Storage.

DAILY USEEveryday community or church storage
Everyday community or church storage
720 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a community or church storage.
STORAGE OVERFLOWcommunity or church storage + seasonal storage
community or church storage + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×24 Community or Church Storage, what makes it different.

720sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$263/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×24 community or church storage is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $263/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×24?

720 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 24′ footprint with 720 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $5,760–$8,640 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Community or Church Storage shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×24 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×24 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×24 Community or Church Storage buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×24 Community or Church Storage

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Community or Church Storage · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×25×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$3,240+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Community or Church Storage also viewed:

🏡 30×24

Three-Car Detached Garage

30×24 three-car detached garage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Three-Car Detached Garage →

🏡 30×24

Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay

30×24 two-car garage plus workshop bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Two-Car Garage Plus Workshop Bay →

🎯 30×24

RV Cover With Side Storage

30×24 rv cover with side storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover With Side Storage →

🌾 30×24

Hobby Farm Equipment Shed

30×24 hobby farm equipment shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobby Farm Equipment Shed →

🏢 30×24

Small Business Shop

30×24 small business shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Business Shop →

🏡 30×24

Man Cave or She Shed

30×24 man cave or she shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Man Cave or She Shed →

🌾 30×24

Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter

30×24 small horse barn or animal shelter configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$11,300Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Small Horse Barn or Animal Shelter →

🏭 30×24

Welding & Fabrication Shop

30×24 welding & fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,900Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Welding & Fabrication Shop →

🎯 30×24

Boat & Trailer Storage

30×24 boat & trailer storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Boat & Trailer Storage →

🏡 30×24

Detached Home Gym

30×24 detached home gym configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$10,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Detached Home Gym →

🏢 30×24

Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay

30×24 auto detailing or fleet bay configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$12,500Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Auto Detailing or Fleet Bay →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Community or Church Storage questions, answered.

How much does a 30×24 community or church storage cost?

A 30×24 community or church storage from Steel and Stud starts at $12,600 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $263/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×24 community or church storage price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud community or church storage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×24 community or church storage?

Almost always for 720+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud community or church storage different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×24 community or church storage need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×24 community or church storage delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×24 community or church storage without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $263/month on a 30×24 community or church storage.

What warranty comes with the 30×24 community or church storage?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×24 community or church storage in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×24 community or church storage pass community-use and assembly inspections?

Yes. Steel and Stud’s engineered drawings include load calculations, accessibility paths, and egress widths required by most jurisdictions for assembly and institutional use. Stamped, sealed PE drawings are included free with every order.

Ready to build?

Your Community or Church Storage quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$12,600.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
White steel structure event venue with black-framed glass entry and fountains in a modern courtyard

30×24 Community or Church Storage

720 sq ft for compact garage, RV cover, or carport

30′ x 24′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×24 steel building delivers 720 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$12,600.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Green steel carport with cream trim covering a truck and SUV by a lake at dusk

30×51 Metal Carport (Open)

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×51 Metal Carport (Open) | Steel and Stud, From $23,800

12

30×51 Metal Carport (Open)
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$27,150$23,800SAVE $3,350
or $496/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×51Metal Carport (Open)

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×51 Metal Carport (Open), built for daily backyard use.

Our 30×51 metal carport (open) fits 30-foot widths and 51-foot lengths to give you a finished daily-use building without contractor pricing. Cheapest 30×51 steel building configuration. Cover up to 6 vehicles, ATVs.

You’re viewing:Metal Carport (Open)·Size30×51·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$23,800$27,150Save $3,350
or as low as $496/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×51
30×51
this size
$23,800
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,530 sq ft enclosed
  • From $8,995
  • 3 Roof Styles
  • Free Install
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X51-METAL-CARPORT-OPBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your open-cover layout.

30 feet wide × 51 feet long. Our 30×51 metal carport (open) fits 30-foot widths and 51-foot lengths to give you a finished daily-use building without contractor pricing.

Cover bayPillar zoneApproach apron30′ × 51′ · 1,530 sq ft · open-cover layout

Cover bay · Pillar zone · Approach apron

Cover bay at the front, pillar zone in the middle, approach apron at the rear. Cheapest 30×51 steel building configuration.

💡 Pro tip:Metal Carport (Open) at 30×51, add insulation + electrical for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×51 Metal Carport (Open) in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Metal Carport (Open).

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,530 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×51 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Metal Carport (Open) spec sheet.

Width30′
Length51′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,530 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Metal Carport (Open).

DAILY USEEveryday metal carport (open)
Everyday metal carport (open)
1,530 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a metal carport (open).
STORAGE OVERFLOWmetal carport (open) + seasonal storage
metal carport (open) + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×51 Metal Carport (Open), what makes it different.

1,530sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$496/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×51 metal carport (open) is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $496/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×51?

1,530 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 51′ footprint with 1,530 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $12,240–$18,360 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Metal Carport (Open) shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×51 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×51 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×51 Metal Carport (Open) buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×51 Metal Carport (Open)

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Metal Carport (Open) · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×52×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$6,885+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Metal Carport (Open) also viewed:

🏡 30×51

Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage)

30×51 metal garage (4 cars + storage) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage) →

🏡 30×51

Workshop / Hobby Space

30×51 workshop / hobby space configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Workshop / Hobby Space →

🏢 30×51

Commercial Steel Building

30×51 commercial steel building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Steel Building →

🏡 30×51

RV Cover / Boat Storage

30×51 rv cover / boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover / Boat Storage →

🎯 30×51

Home Gym / Studio

30×51 home gym / studio configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Home Gym / Studio →

🌾 30×51

Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) →

🎯 30×51

Backyard Studio / Retreat

30×51 backyard studio / retreat configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Backyard Studio / Retreat →

🏭 30×51

Factory / Warehouse

30×51 factory / warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$26,050Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Factory / Warehouse →

🏛️ 30×51

Government / Institutional

30×51 government / institutional configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Government / Institutional →

🌾 30×51

Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

30×51 equestrian arena / tack room configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equestrian Arena / Tack Room →

🏛️ 30×51

Houses of Worship

30×51 houses of worship configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Houses of Worship →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Metal Carport (Open) questions, answered.

How much does a 30×51 metal carport (open) cost?

A 30×51 metal carport (open) from Steel and Stud starts at $23,800 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $496/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×51 metal carport (open) price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud metal carport (open) ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×51 metal carport (open)?

Almost always for 1,530+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud metal carport (open) different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×51 metal carport (open) need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×51 metal carport (open) delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×51 metal carport (open) without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $496/month on a 30×51 metal carport (open).

What warranty comes with the 30×51 metal carport (open)?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×51 metal carport (open) in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does a 30×51 metal carport (open) add resale value to my home?

An enclosed 30×51 metal carport (open) typically adds $12,240–$18,360 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.

Ready to build?

Your Metal Carport (Open) quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$23,800.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Green steel carport with cream trim covering a truck and SUV by a lake at dusk

30×51 Metal Carport (Open)

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$23,800.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Green prefab metal building with cream roll up door and shop sign below mountain peaks

30×51 Workshop / Hobby Space

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×51 Workshop / Hobby Space | Steel and Stud, From $23,800

12

30×51 Workshop / Hobby Space
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$27,150$23,800SAVE $3,350
or $496/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×51Workshop / Hobby Space

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×51 Workshop / Hobby Space, built for daily backyard use.

Looking for a 30×51 workshop / hobby space? At 1530 sq ft, this footprint suits homeowners adding garage, workshop, or hobby space. 1,1530 sq ft clear-span steel workshop for woodworking, auto repair, welding.

You’re viewing:Workshop / Hobby Space·Size30×51·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$23,800$27,150Save $3,350
or as low as $496/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×51
30×51
this size
$23,800
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,530 sq ft enclosed
  • From style=”margin-top:18px”4,995
  • Clear Span
  • 14 Gauge
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X51-WORKSHOP-HOBBY-SBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your workshop layout.

30 feet wide × 51 feet long. Side-load + walk-in, dust-collection ready. Looking for a 30×51 workshop / hobby space? At 1530 sq ft, this footprint suits homeowners adding garage, workshop, or hobby space.

Workbench wallTABLE SAW / CENTERLumber / Material rack30′ × 51′ · 1,530 sq ft · workshop layout

Workbench wall · Table saw / Center · Lumber / Material rack

Workbench wall at the front, table saw / center in the middle, lumber / material rack at the rear. Capacity: 1-person serious shop. 1,1530 sq ft clear-span steel workshop for woodworking, auto repair, welding, fabrication, and crafts.

💡 Pro tip:Size affords: dust collection, 220V subpanel, shop sink.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×51 Workshop / Hobby Space in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Workshop / Hobby Space.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,530 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×51 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Workshop / Hobby Space spec sheet.

Width30′
Length51′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,530 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Workshop / Hobby Space.

DAILY USEEveryday workshop / hobby space
Everyday workshop / hobby space
1,530 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a workshop / hobby space.
STORAGE OVERFLOWworkshop / hobby space + seasonal storage
workshop / hobby space + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×51 Workshop / Hobby Space, what makes it different.

1,530sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$496/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×51 workshop / hobby space is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $496/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×51?

1,530 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 51′ footprint with 1,530 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $12,240–$18,360 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Workshop / Hobby Space shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×51 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×51 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×51 Workshop / Hobby Space buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×51 Workshop / Hobby Space

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Workshop / Hobby Space · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×52×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$6,885+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Workshop / Hobby Space also viewed:

🏡 30×51

Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage)

30×51 metal garage (4 cars + storage) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage) →

🏡 30×51

Metal Carport (Open)

30×51 metal carport (open) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Carport (Open) →

🏢 30×51

Commercial Steel Building

30×51 commercial steel building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Steel Building →

🏡 30×51

RV Cover / Boat Storage

30×51 rv cover / boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover / Boat Storage →

🎯 30×51

Home Gym / Studio

30×51 home gym / studio configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Home Gym / Studio →

🌾 30×51

Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) →

🎯 30×51

Backyard Studio / Retreat

30×51 backyard studio / retreat configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Backyard Studio / Retreat →

🏭 30×51

Factory / Warehouse

30×51 factory / warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$26,050Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Factory / Warehouse →

🏛️ 30×51

Government / Institutional

30×51 government / institutional configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Government / Institutional →

🌾 30×51

Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

30×51 equestrian arena / tack room configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equestrian Arena / Tack Room →

🏛️ 30×51

Houses of Worship

30×51 houses of worship configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Houses of Worship →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Workshop / Hobby Space questions, answered.

How much does a 30×51 workshop / hobby space cost?

A 30×51 workshop / hobby space from Steel and Stud starts at $23,800 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $496/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×51 workshop / hobby space price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud workshop / hobby space ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×51 workshop / hobby space?

Almost always for 1,530+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud workshop / hobby space different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×51 workshop / hobby space need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×51 workshop / hobby space delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×51 workshop / hobby space without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $496/month on a 30×51 workshop / hobby space.

What warranty comes with the 30×51 workshop / hobby space?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×51 workshop / hobby space in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does a 30×51 workshop / hobby space add resale value to my home?

An enclosed 30×51 workshop / hobby space typically adds $12,240–$18,360 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.

Ready to build?

Your Workshop / Hobby Space quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$23,800.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Green prefab metal building with cream roll up door and shop sign below mountain peaks

30×51 Workshop / Hobby Space

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$23,800.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Tan steel building with dark brown trim and entry door set in desert landscaping

30×51 Commercial Steel Building

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×51 Commercial Steel Building | Steel and Stud, From $25,650

12

30×51 Commercial Steel Building
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$29,250$25,650SAVE $3,600
or $534/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×51Commercial Steel Building

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×51 Commercial Steel Building, engineered for code-compliant business use.

30×51 delivers 1530 sq ft of code-compliant commercial steel building space. Retail spaces, offices, auto detailing bays, service businesses, storage warehouses, and light commercial use. Code-certified clear-span.

You’re viewing:Commercial Steel Building·Size30×51·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$25,650$29,250Save $3,600
or as low as $534/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×51
30×51
this size
$25,650
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,530 sq ft enclosed
  • From style=”margin-top:18px”8,500
  • Code Certified
  • 12 Gauge
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X51-COMMERCIAL-STEELBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your commercial steel building layout.

30 feet wide × 51 feet long. 30×51 delivers 1530 sq ft of code-compliant commercial steel building space.

Car 1Car 2OFFICE30′ × 51′ · 1,530 sq ft · commercial steel building layout

Commercial Steel Building layout.

30×51 delivers 1530 sq ft of code-compliant commercial steel building space. Retail spaces, offices, auto detailing bays, service businesses, storage warehouses, and light commercial use. Code-certified clear-span design with 12-gauge framing maximizes every square foot of usable space.

💡 Pro tip:Commercial Steel Building at 30×51, add insulation + electrical for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×51 Commercial Steel Building in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Commercial Steel Building.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,530 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×51 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Commercial Steel Building spec sheet.

Width30′
Length51′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,530 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Commercial Steel Building.

DAILY USEEveryday commercial steel building
Everyday commercial steel building
1,530 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a commercial steel building.
STORAGE OVERFLOWcommercial steel building + seasonal storage
commercial steel building + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×51 Commercial Steel Building, what makes it different.

1,530sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$534/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×51 commercial steel building is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $534/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×51?

1,530 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 51′ footprint with 1,530 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $12,240–$18,360 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Commercial Steel Building shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×51 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×51 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×51 Commercial Steel Building buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×51 Commercial Steel Building

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Commercial Steel Building · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×52×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$6,885+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Commercial Steel Building also viewed:

🏡 30×51

Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage)

30×51 metal garage (4 cars + storage) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage) →

🏡 30×51

Workshop / Hobby Space

30×51 workshop / hobby space configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Workshop / Hobby Space →

🏡 30×51

Metal Carport (Open)

30×51 metal carport (open) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Carport (Open) →

🏡 30×51

RV Cover / Boat Storage

30×51 rv cover / boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover / Boat Storage →

🎯 30×51

Home Gym / Studio

30×51 home gym / studio configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Home Gym / Studio →

🌾 30×51

Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) →

🎯 30×51

Backyard Studio / Retreat

30×51 backyard studio / retreat configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Backyard Studio / Retreat →

🏭 30×51

Factory / Warehouse

30×51 factory / warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$26,050Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Factory / Warehouse →

🏛️ 30×51

Government / Institutional

30×51 government / institutional configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Government / Institutional →

🌾 30×51

Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

30×51 equestrian arena / tack room configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equestrian Arena / Tack Room →

🏛️ 30×51

Houses of Worship

30×51 houses of worship configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Houses of Worship →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Commercial Steel Building questions, answered.

How much does a 30×51 commercial steel building cost?

A 30×51 commercial steel building from Steel and Stud starts at $25,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $534/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×51 commercial steel building price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud commercial steel building ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×51 commercial steel building?

Almost always for 1,530+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud commercial steel building different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×51 commercial steel building need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×51 commercial steel building delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×51 commercial steel building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $534/month on a 30×51 commercial steel building.

What warranty comes with the 30×51 commercial steel building?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×51 commercial steel building in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does the 30×51 commercial steel building meet IBC commercial code?

Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.

Ready to build?

Your Commercial Steel Building quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$25,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Tan steel building with dark brown trim and entry door set in desert landscaping

30×51 Commercial Steel Building

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$25,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Forest green metal building with cream roll-up door and lean-to RV port over camper

30×51 RV Cover / Boat Storage

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×51 RV Cover / Boat Storage | Steel and Stud, From $23,800

12

30×51 RV Cover / Boat Storage
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$27,150$23,800SAVE $3,350
or $496/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×51RV Cover / Boat Storage

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×51 RV Cover / Boat Storage, built for daily backyard use.

Our 30×51 rv cover / boat storage fits 30-foot widths and 51-foot lengths to give you a finished daily-use building without contractor pricing. Year-round protection for RVs, travel trailers, boats, jet skis, work.

You’re viewing:RV Cover / Boat Storage·Size30×51·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$23,800$27,150Save $3,350
or as low as $496/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×51
30×51
this size
$23,800
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,530 sq ft enclosed
  • From $9,995
  • Up to 16 Tall
  • 12’W Door
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X51-RV-COVER-BOAT-STBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-RV garage.

30 feet wide × 51 feet long. 16-ft+ clear height for tall slides + roof AC. Our 30×51 rv cover / boat storage fits 30-foot widths and 51-foot lengths to give you a finished daily-use building without contractor pricing.

MULTIPLE RV BAYSService / wash bayStorage + workshop30′ × 51′ · 1,530 sq ft · multi-RV garage

Multiple RV bays · Service / wash bay · Storage + workshop

Multiple RV bays at the front, service / wash bay in the middle, storage + workshop at the rear. Capacity: 2 Class A’s or RV + boat + daily driver. Year-round protection for RVs, travel trailers, boats, jet skis, work trucks, and towable campers.

💡 Pro tip:Size affords: multiple hookups, wash + dump, tool wall.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×51 RV Cover / Boat Storage in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your RV Cover / Boat Storage.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,530 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×51 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

RV Cover / Boat Storage spec sheet.

Width30′
Length51′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,530 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use RV Cover / Boat Storage.

DAILY USEEveryday rv cover / boat storage
Everyday rv cover / boat storage
1,530 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a rv cover / boat storage.
STORAGE OVERFLOWrv cover / boat storage + seasonal storage
rv cover / boat storage + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×51 RV Cover / Boat Storage, what makes it different.

1,530sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$496/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×51 rv cover / boat storage is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $496/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×51?

1,530 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 51′ footprint with 1,530 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $12,240–$18,360 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from RV Cover / Boat Storage shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×51 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×51 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×51 RV Cover / Boat Storage buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×51 RV Cover / Boat Storage

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your RV Cover / Boat Storage · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×52×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$6,885+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose RV Cover / Boat Storage also viewed:

🏡 30×51

Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage)

30×51 metal garage (4 cars + storage) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage) →

🏡 30×51

Workshop / Hobby Space

30×51 workshop / hobby space configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Workshop / Hobby Space →

🏡 30×51

Metal Carport (Open)

30×51 metal carport (open) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Carport (Open) →

🏢 30×51

Commercial Steel Building

30×51 commercial steel building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Steel Building →

🎯 30×51

Home Gym / Studio

30×51 home gym / studio configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Home Gym / Studio →

🌾 30×51

Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) →

🎯 30×51

Backyard Studio / Retreat

30×51 backyard studio / retreat configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Backyard Studio / Retreat →

🏭 30×51

Factory / Warehouse

30×51 factory / warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$26,050Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Factory / Warehouse →

🏛️ 30×51

Government / Institutional

30×51 government / institutional configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Government / Institutional →

🌾 30×51

Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

30×51 equestrian arena / tack room configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equestrian Arena / Tack Room →

🏛️ 30×51

Houses of Worship

30×51 houses of worship configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Houses of Worship →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

RV Cover / Boat Storage questions, answered.

How much does a 30×51 rv cover / boat storage cost?

A 30×51 rv cover / boat storage from Steel and Stud starts at $23,800 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $496/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×51 rv cover / boat storage price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud rv cover / boat storage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×51 rv cover / boat storage?

Almost always for 1,530+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud rv cover / boat storage different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×51 rv cover / boat storage need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×51 rv cover / boat storage delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×51 rv cover / boat storage without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $496/month on a 30×51 rv cover / boat storage.

What warranty comes with the 30×51 rv cover / boat storage?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×51 rv cover / boat storage in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does a 30×51 rv cover / boat storage add resale value to my home?

An enclosed 30×51 rv cover / boat storage typically adds $12,240–$18,360 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.

Ready to build?

Your RV Cover / Boat Storage quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$23,800.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Forest green metal building with cream roll-up door and lean-to RV port over camper

30×51 RV Cover / Boat Storage

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$23,800.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Hip roof prefab metal building in warm wood brown with glass panels and exercise bike

30×51 Home Gym / Studio

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×51 Home Gym / Studio | Steel and Stud, From $23,800

12

30×51 Home Gym / Studio
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$27,150$23,800SAVE $3,350
or $496/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×51Home Gym / Studio

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×51 Home Gym / Studio, built for hobby and recreational use.

Our 30×51 home gym / studio fits 30-foot widths and 51-foot lengths to give you a comfortable hobby retreat with sidewall room to spare. Private 1,1530 sq ft fitness space with high ceilings, durable floors, and full.

You’re viewing:Home Gym / Studio·Size30×51·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$23,800$27,150Save $3,350
or as low as $496/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×51
30×51
this size
$23,800
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,530 sq ft enclosed
  • From style=”margin-top:18px”4,995
  • Insulated
  • Wired Ready
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X51-HOME-GYM-STUDIOBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your home-gym layout.

30 feet wide × 51 feet long. Our 30×51 home gym / studio fits 30-foot widths and 51-foot lengths to give you a comfortable hobby retreat with sidewall room to spare.

Cardio zoneWeight rackStretch / Bench30′ × 51′ · 1,530 sq ft · home-gym layout

Cardio zone · Weight rack · Stretch / Bench

Cardio zone at the front, weight rack in the middle, stretch / bench at the rear. Private 1,1530 sq ft fitness space with high ceilings, durable floors, and full insulation for year-round training.

💡 Pro tip:Home Gym / Studio at 30×51, add insulation + electrical for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×51 Home Gym / Studio in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Home Gym / Studio.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,530 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×51 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Home Gym / Studio spec sheet.

Width30′
Length51′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,530 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Home Gym / Studio.

DAILY USEEveryday home gym / studio
Everyday home gym / studio
1,530 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a home gym / studio.
STORAGE OVERFLOWhome gym / studio + seasonal storage
home gym / studio + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×51 Home Gym / Studio, what makes it different.

1,530sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$496/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×51 home gym / studio is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $496/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×51?

1,530 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 51′ footprint with 1,530 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $12,240–$18,360 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Home Gym / Studio shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×51 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×51 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×51 Home Gym / Studio buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×51 Home Gym / Studio

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Home Gym / Studio · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×52×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$6,885+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Home Gym / Studio also viewed:

🏡 30×51

Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage)

30×51 metal garage (4 cars + storage) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage) →

🏡 30×51

Workshop / Hobby Space

30×51 workshop / hobby space configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Workshop / Hobby Space →

🏡 30×51

Metal Carport (Open)

30×51 metal carport (open) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Carport (Open) →

🏢 30×51

Commercial Steel Building

30×51 commercial steel building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Steel Building →

🏡 30×51

RV Cover / Boat Storage

30×51 rv cover / boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover / Boat Storage →

🌾 30×51

Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) →

🎯 30×51

Backyard Studio / Retreat

30×51 backyard studio / retreat configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Backyard Studio / Retreat →

🏭 30×51

Factory / Warehouse

30×51 factory / warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$26,050Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Factory / Warehouse →

🏛️ 30×51

Government / Institutional

30×51 government / institutional configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Government / Institutional →

🌾 30×51

Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

30×51 equestrian arena / tack room configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equestrian Arena / Tack Room →

🏛️ 30×51

Houses of Worship

30×51 houses of worship configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Houses of Worship →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Home Gym / Studio questions, answered.

How much does a 30×51 home gym / studio cost?

A 30×51 home gym / studio from Steel and Stud starts at $23,800 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $496/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×51 home gym / studio price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud home gym / studio ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×51 home gym / studio?

Almost always for 1,530+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud home gym / studio different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×51 home gym / studio need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×51 home gym / studio delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×51 home gym / studio without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $496/month on a 30×51 home gym / studio.

What warranty comes with the 30×51 home gym / studio?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×51 home gym / studio in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Can I insulate the 30×51 home gym / studio for year-round use?

Yes, Steel and Stud offers R-13 wall + R-19 ceiling insulation packages, and the interior is drywall-ready. Most owners finish a home gym / studio to a livable retreat in 2–3 weekends. Add a mini-split HVAC at checkout for full four-season comfort.

Ready to build?

Your Home Gym / Studio quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$23,800.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Hip roof prefab metal building in warm wood brown with glass panels and exercise bike

30×51 Home Gym / Studio

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$23,800.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Barn red steel barn with white sliding doors and round hay bales stacked beside it

30×51 Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×51 Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) | Steel and Stud, From $24,450

12

30×51 Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$27,850$24,450SAVE $3,400
or $509/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×51Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×51 Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch), built for farm and ranch demands.

30×51 delivers 1530 sq ft of rugged metal barn (farm & ranch) space. Tractor barn, hay storage, livestock shelter, or feed barn. Heavy-duty galvanized steel handles harsh agricultural use, and the 30-foot width improves.

You’re viewing:Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)·Size30×51·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$24,450$27,850Save $3,400
or as low as $509/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×51
30×51
this size
$24,450
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,530 sq ft enclosed
  • From style=”margin-top:18px”2,500
  • Lean-To Ready
  • Heavy Duty
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X51-METAL-BARN-FARM-Built:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your livestock-barn layout.

30 feet wide × 51 feet long. 30×51 delivers 1530 sq ft of rugged metal barn (farm & ranch) space.

Livestock areaCENTER ALLEYFeed / Storage30′ × 51′ · 1,530 sq ft · livestock-barn layout

Livestock area · Center alley · Feed / Storage

Livestock area at the front, center alley in the middle, feed / storage at the rear. Tractor barn, hay storage, livestock shelter, or feed barn.

💡 Pro tip:Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) at 30×51, add insulation + electrical for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×51 Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch).

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,530 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×51 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) spec sheet.

Width30′
Length51′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,530 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch).

DAILY USEEveryday metal barn (farm & ranch)
Everyday metal barn (farm & ranch)
1,530 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a metal barn (farm & ranch).
STORAGE OVERFLOWmetal barn (farm & ranch) + seasonal storage
metal barn (farm & ranch) + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×51 Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch), what makes it different.

1,530sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$509/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $509/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×51?

1,530 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 51′ footprint with 1,530 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $12,240–$18,360 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×51 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×51 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×51 Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×51 Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×52×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$6,885+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) also viewed:

🏡 30×51

Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage)

30×51 metal garage (4 cars + storage) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage) →

🏡 30×51

Workshop / Hobby Space

30×51 workshop / hobby space configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Workshop / Hobby Space →

🏡 30×51

Metal Carport (Open)

30×51 metal carport (open) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Carport (Open) →

🏢 30×51

Commercial Steel Building

30×51 commercial steel building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Steel Building →

🏡 30×51

RV Cover / Boat Storage

30×51 rv cover / boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover / Boat Storage →

🎯 30×51

Home Gym / Studio

30×51 home gym / studio configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Home Gym / Studio →

🎯 30×51

Backyard Studio / Retreat

30×51 backyard studio / retreat configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Backyard Studio / Retreat →

🏭 30×51

Factory / Warehouse

30×51 factory / warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$26,050Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Factory / Warehouse →

🏛️ 30×51

Government / Institutional

30×51 government / institutional configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Government / Institutional →

🌾 30×51

Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

30×51 equestrian arena / tack room configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equestrian Arena / Tack Room →

🏛️ 30×51

Houses of Worship

30×51 houses of worship configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Houses of Worship →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) questions, answered.

How much does a 30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) cost?

A 30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) from Steel and Stud starts at $24,450 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $509/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud metal barn (farm & ranch) ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch)?

Almost always for 1,530+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud metal barn (farm & ranch) different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $509/month on a 30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch).

What warranty comes with the 30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch)?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?

The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.

Ready to build?

Your Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$24,450.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Barn red steel barn with white sliding doors and round hay bales stacked beside it

30×51 Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$24,450.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Green prefab metal building at dusk with lit picture windows showing a home hobby studio inside

30×51 Backyard Studio / Retreat

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×51 Backyard Studio / Retreat | Steel and Stud, From $23,800

12

30×51 Backyard Studio / Retreat
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$27,150$23,800SAVE $3,350
or $496/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×51Backyard Studio / Retreat

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×51 Backyard Studio / Retreat, built for hobby and recreational use.

30×51 delivers 1530 sq ft of hobby-ready backyard studio / retreat space. Personal retreat away from the house. Game room, music studio, art workshop, lounge, or backyard studio with room to divide activity zones. Fully.

You’re viewing:Backyard Studio / Retreat·Size30×51·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$23,800$27,150Save $3,350
or as low as $496/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×51
30×51
this size
$23,800
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,530 sq ft enclosed
  • From style=”margin-top:18px”4,995
  • Insulated
  • Walk-In Door
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X51-BACKYARD-STUDIO-Built:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your home-office layout.

30 feet wide × 51 feet long. 30×51 delivers 1530 sq ft of hobby-ready backyard studio / retreat space.

Work zoneMeeting / deskStorage / Mech30′ × 51′ · 1,530 sq ft · home-office layout

Work zone · Meeting / desk · Storage / Mech

Work zone at the front, meeting / desk in the middle, storage / mech at the rear. Personal retreat away from the house.

💡 Pro tip:Backyard Studio / Retreat at 30×51, add insulation + electrical for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×51 Backyard Studio / Retreat in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Backyard Studio / Retreat.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,530 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×51 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Backyard Studio / Retreat spec sheet.

Width30′
Length51′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,530 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Backyard Studio / Retreat.

DAILY USEEveryday backyard studio / retreat
Everyday backyard studio / retreat
1,530 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a backyard studio / retreat.
STORAGE OVERFLOWbackyard studio / retreat + seasonal storage
backyard studio / retreat + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×51 Backyard Studio / Retreat, what makes it different.

1,530sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$496/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×51 backyard studio / retreat is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $496/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×51?

1,530 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 51′ footprint with 1,530 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $12,240–$18,360 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Backyard Studio / Retreat shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×51 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×51 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×51 Backyard Studio / Retreat buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×51 Backyard Studio / Retreat

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Backyard Studio / Retreat · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×52×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$6,885+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Backyard Studio / Retreat also viewed:

🏡 30×51

Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage)

30×51 metal garage (4 cars + storage) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage) →

🏡 30×51

Workshop / Hobby Space

30×51 workshop / hobby space configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Workshop / Hobby Space →

🏡 30×51

Metal Carport (Open)

30×51 metal carport (open) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Carport (Open) →

🏢 30×51

Commercial Steel Building

30×51 commercial steel building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Steel Building →

🏡 30×51

RV Cover / Boat Storage

30×51 rv cover / boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover / Boat Storage →

🎯 30×51

Home Gym / Studio

30×51 home gym / studio configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Home Gym / Studio →

🌾 30×51

Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) →

🏭 30×51

Factory / Warehouse

30×51 factory / warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$26,050Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Factory / Warehouse →

🏛️ 30×51

Government / Institutional

30×51 government / institutional configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Government / Institutional →

🌾 30×51

Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

30×51 equestrian arena / tack room configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equestrian Arena / Tack Room →

🏛️ 30×51

Houses of Worship

30×51 houses of worship configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Houses of Worship →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Backyard Studio / Retreat questions, answered.

How much does a 30×51 backyard studio / retreat cost?

A 30×51 backyard studio / retreat from Steel and Stud starts at $23,800 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $496/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×51 backyard studio / retreat price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud backyard studio / retreat ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×51 backyard studio / retreat?

Almost always for 1,530+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud backyard studio / retreat different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×51 backyard studio / retreat need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×51 backyard studio / retreat delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×51 backyard studio / retreat without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $496/month on a 30×51 backyard studio / retreat.

What warranty comes with the 30×51 backyard studio / retreat?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×51 backyard studio / retreat in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Can I insulate the 30×51 backyard studio / retreat for year-round use?

Yes, Steel and Stud offers R-13 wall + R-19 ceiling insulation packages, and the interior is drywall-ready. Most owners finish a backyard studio / retreat to a livable retreat in 2–3 weekends. Add a mini-split HVAC at checkout for full four-season comfort.

Ready to build?

Your Backyard Studio / Retreat quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$23,800.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Green prefab metal building at dusk with lit picture windows showing a home hobby studio inside

30×51 Backyard Studio / Retreat

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$23,800.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Red steel building with white roll up door, steel beams and forklift in work yard

30×51 Factory / Warehouse

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×51 Factory / Warehouse | Steel and Stud, From $26,050

12

30×51 Factory / Warehouse
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$29,700$26,050SAVE $3,650
or $543/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×51Factory / Warehouse

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×51 Factory / Warehouse, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.

Built for industrial buyers managing equipment and inventory, this 30×51 factory / warehouse packs 1530 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Inventory staging, service bays, equipment storage, and light production.

You’re viewing:Factory / Warehouse·Size30×51·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$26,050$29,700Save $3,650
or as low as $543/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×51
30×51
this size
$26,050
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,530 sq ft enclosed
  • From style=”margin-top:18px”8,500
  • Code Certified
  • 12 Gauge
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X51-FACTORY-WAREHOUSBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your small-business warehouse.

30 feet wide × 51 feet long. Single roll-up door, hand-truck operation. Built for industrial buyers managing equipment and inventory, this 30×51 factory / warehouse packs 1530 sq ft into a code-compliant shell.

Loading areaINVENTORY RACKSOffice corner30′ × 51′ · 1,530 sq ft · small-business warehouse

Loading area · Inventory racks · Office corner

Loading area at the front, inventory racks in the middle, office corner at the rear. Capacity: ~30 pallet positions. Inventory staging, service bays, equipment storage, and light production.

💡 Pro tip:Size affords: shelving, desk + computer.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×51 Factory / Warehouse in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Factory / Warehouse.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,530 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×51 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Factory / Warehouse spec sheet.

Width30′
Length51′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,530 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Factory / Warehouse.

DAILY USEEveryday factory / warehouse
Everyday factory / warehouse
1,530 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a factory / warehouse.
STORAGE OVERFLOWfactory / warehouse + seasonal storage
factory / warehouse + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×51 Factory / Warehouse, what makes it different.

1,530sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$543/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×51 factory / warehouse is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $543/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×51?

1,530 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 51′ footprint with 1,530 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $12,240–$18,360 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Factory / Warehouse shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×51 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×51 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×51 Factory / Warehouse buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×51 Factory / Warehouse

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Factory / Warehouse · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×52×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$6,885+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Factory / Warehouse also viewed:

🏡 30×51

Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage)

30×51 metal garage (4 cars + storage) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage) →

🏡 30×51

Workshop / Hobby Space

30×51 workshop / hobby space configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Workshop / Hobby Space →

🏡 30×51

Metal Carport (Open)

30×51 metal carport (open) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Carport (Open) →

🏢 30×51

Commercial Steel Building

30×51 commercial steel building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Steel Building →

🏡 30×51

RV Cover / Boat Storage

30×51 rv cover / boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover / Boat Storage →

🎯 30×51

Home Gym / Studio

30×51 home gym / studio configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Home Gym / Studio →

🌾 30×51

Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) →

🎯 30×51

Backyard Studio / Retreat

30×51 backyard studio / retreat configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Backyard Studio / Retreat →

🏛️ 30×51

Government / Institutional

30×51 government / institutional configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Government / Institutional →

🌾 30×51

Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

30×51 equestrian arena / tack room configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equestrian Arena / Tack Room →

🏛️ 30×51

Houses of Worship

30×51 houses of worship configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Houses of Worship →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Factory / Warehouse questions, answered.

How much does a 30×51 factory / warehouse cost?

A 30×51 factory / warehouse from Steel and Stud starts at $26,050 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $543/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×51 factory / warehouse price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud factory / warehouse ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×51 factory / warehouse?

Almost always for 1,530+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud factory / warehouse different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×51 factory / warehouse need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×51 factory / warehouse delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×51 factory / warehouse without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $543/month on a 30×51 factory / warehouse.

What warranty comes with the 30×51 factory / warehouse?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×51 factory / warehouse in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×51 factory / warehouse handle heavy equipment and forklifts?

Standard 30×51 factory / warehouse ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.

Ready to build?

Your Factory / Warehouse quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$26,050.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Red steel building with white roll up door, steel beams and forklift in work yard

30×51 Factory / Warehouse

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$26,050.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Forest green steel structure at snowy dawn with a salt spreader truck in the lit bay

30×51 Government / Institutional

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×51 Government / Institutional | Steel and Stud, From $25,750

12

30×51 Government / Institutional
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$29,350$25,750SAVE $3,600
or $536/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×51Government / Institutional

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×51 Government / Institutional, engineered to code for assembly use.

30×51 delivers 1530 sq ft of public-use government / institutional space. Evacuation shelters, municipal equipment storage, field offices, and emergency response staging. Engineered up to 170+ MPH wind ratings with.

You’re viewing:Government / Institutional·Size30×51·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$25,750$29,350Save $3,600
or as low as $536/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×51
30×51
this size
$25,750
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,530 sq ft enclosed
  • Engineered
  • 170+ MPH
  • Fire Code
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X51-GOVERNMENT-INSTIBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your government / institutional layout.

30 feet wide × 51 feet long. 30×51 delivers 1530 sq ft of public-use government / institutional space.

Car 1Car 2OFFICE30′ × 51′ · 1,530 sq ft · government / institutional layout

Government / Institutional layout.

30×51 delivers 1530 sq ft of public-use government / institutional space. Evacuation shelters, municipal equipment storage, field offices, and emergency response staging. Engineered up to 170+ MPH wind ratings with stamped permit-ready drawings.

💡 Pro tip:Government / Institutional at 30×51, add insulation + electrical for year-round use.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×51 Government / Institutional in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Government / Institutional.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,530 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×51 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Government / Institutional spec sheet.

Width30′
Length51′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,530 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Government / Institutional.

DAILY USEEveryday government / institutional
Everyday government / institutional
1,530 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a government / institutional.
STORAGE OVERFLOWgovernment / institutional + seasonal storage
government / institutional + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×51 Government / Institutional, what makes it different.

1,530sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$536/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×51 government / institutional is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $536/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×51?

1,530 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 51′ footprint with 1,530 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $12,240–$18,360 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Government / Institutional shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×51 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×51 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×51 Government / Institutional buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×51 Government / Institutional

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Government / Institutional · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×52×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$6,885+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Government / Institutional also viewed:

🏡 30×51

Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage)

30×51 metal garage (4 cars + storage) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage) →

🏡 30×51

Workshop / Hobby Space

30×51 workshop / hobby space configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Workshop / Hobby Space →

🏡 30×51

Metal Carport (Open)

30×51 metal carport (open) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Carport (Open) →

🏢 30×51

Commercial Steel Building

30×51 commercial steel building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Steel Building →

🏡 30×51

RV Cover / Boat Storage

30×51 rv cover / boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover / Boat Storage →

🎯 30×51

Home Gym / Studio

30×51 home gym / studio configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Home Gym / Studio →

🌾 30×51

Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) →

🎯 30×51

Backyard Studio / Retreat

30×51 backyard studio / retreat configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Backyard Studio / Retreat →

🏭 30×51

Factory / Warehouse

30×51 factory / warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$26,050Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Factory / Warehouse →

🌾 30×51

Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

30×51 equestrian arena / tack room configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equestrian Arena / Tack Room →

🏛️ 30×51

Houses of Worship

30×51 houses of worship configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Houses of Worship →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Government / Institutional questions, answered.

How much does a 30×51 government / institutional cost?

A 30×51 government / institutional from Steel and Stud starts at $25,750 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $536/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×51 government / institutional price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud government / institutional ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×51 government / institutional?

Almost always for 1,530+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud government / institutional different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×51 government / institutional need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×51 government / institutional delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×51 government / institutional without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $536/month on a 30×51 government / institutional.

What warranty comes with the 30×51 government / institutional?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×51 government / institutional in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×51 government / institutional pass community-use and assembly inspections?

Yes. Steel and Stud’s engineered drawings include load calculations, accessibility paths, and egress widths required by most jurisdictions for assembly and institutional use. Stamped, sealed PE drawings are included free with every order.

Ready to build?

Your Government / Institutional quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$25,750.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Forest green steel structure at snowy dawn with a salt spreader truck in the lit bay

30×51 Government / Institutional

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$25,750.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Steel barn interior aisle with wooden horse stalls, timber trusses, and a curious horse

30×51 Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×51 Equestrian Arena / Tack Room | Steel and Stud, From $24,450

12

30×51 Equestrian Arena / Tack Room
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$27,850$24,450SAVE $3,400
or $509/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×51Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×51 Equestrian Arena / Tack Room, built for farm and ranch demands.

30×51 delivers 1530 sq ft of rugged equestrian arena / tack room space. High roof clearance for mounted riders, reinforced flooring for hooves, oversized roll-up doors. Store tack, hay, feed, and groom horses under one.

You’re viewing:Equestrian Arena / Tack Room·Size30×51·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$24,450$27,850Save $3,400
or as low as $509/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×51
30×51
this size
$24,450
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,530 sq ft enclosed
  • Up to 20 Tall
  • Ventilation
  • Heavy Duty
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X51-EQUESTRIAN-ARENABuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your shedrow horse barn.

30 feet wide × 51 feet long. Center-aisle layout with cross-ties. 30×51 delivers 1530 sq ft of rugged equestrian arena / tack room space.

3 stalls10-FT CENTER AISLETack + Feed room30′ × 51′ · 1,530 sq ft · shedrow horse barn

3 stalls · 10-ft center aisle · Tack + Feed room

3 stalls at the front, 10-ft center aisle in the middle, tack + feed room at the rear. Capacity: 3 horses + tack + feed. High roof clearance for mounted riders, reinforced flooring for hooves, oversized roll-up doors.

💡 Pro tip:Size affords: dutch doors per stall, wash bay rough-in, fly system.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×51 Equestrian Arena / Tack Room in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Equestrian Arena / Tack Room.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,530 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×51 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Equestrian Arena / Tack Room spec sheet.

Width30′
Length51′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,530 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Equestrian Arena / Tack Room.

DAILY USEEveryday equestrian arena / tack room
Everyday equestrian arena / tack room
1,530 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a equestrian arena / tack room.
STORAGE OVERFLOWequestrian arena / tack room + seasonal storage
equestrian arena / tack room + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×51 Equestrian Arena / Tack Room, what makes it different.

1,530sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$509/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×51 equestrian arena / tack room is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $509/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×51?

1,530 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 51′ footprint with 1,530 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $12,240–$18,360 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Equestrian Arena / Tack Room shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×51 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×51 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×51 Equestrian Arena / Tack Room buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×51 Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Equestrian Arena / Tack Room · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×52×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$6,885+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Equestrian Arena / Tack Room also viewed:

🏡 30×51

Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage)

30×51 metal garage (4 cars + storage) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage) →

🏡 30×51

Workshop / Hobby Space

30×51 workshop / hobby space configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Workshop / Hobby Space →

🏡 30×51

Metal Carport (Open)

30×51 metal carport (open) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Carport (Open) →

🏢 30×51

Commercial Steel Building

30×51 commercial steel building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Steel Building →

🏡 30×51

RV Cover / Boat Storage

30×51 rv cover / boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover / Boat Storage →

🎯 30×51

Home Gym / Studio

30×51 home gym / studio configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Home Gym / Studio →

🌾 30×51

Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) →

🎯 30×51

Backyard Studio / Retreat

30×51 backyard studio / retreat configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Backyard Studio / Retreat →

🏭 30×51

Factory / Warehouse

30×51 factory / warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$26,050Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Factory / Warehouse →

🏛️ 30×51

Government / Institutional

30×51 government / institutional configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Government / Institutional →

🏛️ 30×51

Houses of Worship

30×51 houses of worship configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Houses of Worship →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Equestrian Arena / Tack Room questions, answered.

How much does a 30×51 equestrian arena / tack room cost?

A 30×51 equestrian arena / tack room from Steel and Stud starts at $24,450 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $509/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×51 equestrian arena / tack room price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud equestrian arena / tack room ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×51 equestrian arena / tack room?

Almost always for 1,530+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud equestrian arena / tack room different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×51 equestrian arena / tack room need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×51 equestrian arena / tack room delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×51 equestrian arena / tack room without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $509/month on a 30×51 equestrian arena / tack room.

What warranty comes with the 30×51 equestrian arena / tack room?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×51 equestrian arena / tack room in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×51 equestrian arena / tack room stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?

The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.

Ready to build?

Your Equestrian Arena / Tack Room quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$24,450.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Steel barn interior aisle with wooden horse stalls, timber trusses, and a curious horse

30×51 Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$24,450.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Barn red commercial metal building beside a white country church with tall steeple

30×51 Houses of Worship

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×51 Houses of Worship | Steel and Stud, From $25,750

12

30×51 Houses of Worship
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$29,350$25,750SAVE $3,600
or $536/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×51Houses of Worship

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×51 Houses of Worship, engineered to code for assembly use.

Looking for a 30×51 houses of worship? At 1530 sq ft, this footprint suits public assembly, community use, or worship space. Churches, mosques, temples, and gurdwaras. Column-free 1,1530 sq ft interior fits flexible.

You’re viewing:Houses of Worship·Size30×51·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$25,750$29,350Save $3,600
or as low as $536/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×51
30×51
this size
$25,750
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,530 sq ft enclosed
  • Clear Span
  • Insulated
  • Code Certified
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X51-HOUSES-WORSHIPBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your worship-hall layout.

30 feet wide × 51 feet long. Center aisle + side aisles, fellowship space at rear. Looking for a 30×51 houses of worship? At 1530 sq ft, this footprint suits public assembly, community use, or worship space.

Sanctuary / AltarPew seatingFOYER + RESTROOMS + CLASSROOMS30′ × 51′ · 1,530 sq ft · worship-hall layout

Sanctuary / Altar · Pew seating · Foyer + Restrooms + Classrooms

Sanctuary / Altar at the front, pew seating in the middle, foyer + restrooms + classrooms at the rear. Capacity: seats ~153 in main sanctuary. Churches, mosques, temples, and gurdwaras.

💡 Pro tip:Size affords: choir riser, baptistry rough-in, classroom partitions.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×51 Houses of Worship in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Houses of Worship.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,530 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×51 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Houses of Worship spec sheet.

Width30′
Length51′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,530 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Houses of Worship.

DAILY USEEveryday houses of worship
Everyday houses of worship
1,530 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a houses of worship.
STORAGE OVERFLOWhouses of worship + seasonal storage
houses of worship + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×51 Houses of Worship, what makes it different.

1,530sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$536/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×51 houses of worship is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $536/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×51?

1,530 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 51′ footprint with 1,530 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $12,240–$18,360 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Houses of Worship shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×51 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×51 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×51 Houses of Worship buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×51 Houses of Worship

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Houses of Worship · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×52×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$6,885+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Houses of Worship also viewed:

🏡 30×51

Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage)

30×51 metal garage (4 cars + storage) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Garage (4 Cars + Storage) →

🏡 30×51

Workshop / Hobby Space

30×51 workshop / hobby space configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Workshop / Hobby Space →

🏡 30×51

Metal Carport (Open)

30×51 metal carport (open) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Carport (Open) →

🏢 30×51

Commercial Steel Building

30×51 commercial steel building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Steel Building →

🏡 30×51

RV Cover / Boat Storage

30×51 rv cover / boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV Cover / Boat Storage →

🎯 30×51

Home Gym / Studio

30×51 home gym / studio configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Home Gym / Studio →

🌾 30×51

Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch)

30×51 metal barn (farm & ranch) configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barn (Farm & Ranch) →

🎯 30×51

Backyard Studio / Retreat

30×51 backyard studio / retreat configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$23,800Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Backyard Studio / Retreat →

🏭 30×51

Factory / Warehouse

30×51 factory / warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$26,050Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Factory / Warehouse →

🏛️ 30×51

Government / Institutional

30×51 government / institutional configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$25,750Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Government / Institutional →

🌾 30×51

Equestrian Arena / Tack Room

30×51 equestrian arena / tack room configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$24,450Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equestrian Arena / Tack Room →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Houses of Worship questions, answered.

How much does a 30×51 houses of worship cost?

A 30×51 houses of worship from Steel and Stud starts at $25,750 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $536/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×51 houses of worship price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud houses of worship ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×51 houses of worship?

Almost always for 1,530+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud houses of worship different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×51 houses of worship need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×51 houses of worship delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×51 houses of worship without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $536/month on a 30×51 houses of worship.

What warranty comes with the 30×51 houses of worship?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×51 houses of worship in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×51 houses of worship pass community-use and assembly inspections?

Yes. Steel and Stud’s engineered drawings include load calculations, accessibility paths, and egress widths required by most jurisdictions for assembly and institutional use. Stamped, sealed PE drawings are included free with every order.

Ready to build?

Your Houses of Worship quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$25,750.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Barn red commercial metal building beside a white country church with tall steeple

30×51 Houses of Worship

1,530 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 51′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×51 steel building delivers 1,530 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$25,750.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Black steel garage workshop with open bay, classic car inside, and vintage motorcycle

30×60 Commercial Garage for Auto Repair

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×60 Commercial Garage for Auto Repair | Steel and Stud, From $29,850

12

30×60 Commercial Garage for Auto Repair
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$34,050$29,850SAVE $4,200
or $622/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×60Commercial Garage for Auto Repair

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×60 Commercial Garage for Auto Repair, engineered for code-compliant business use.

Built for business owners who need fast permitted occupancy, this 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair packs 1800 sq ft into a code-compliant shell. Independent auto shops spec a 30×60 commercial garage to run three.

You’re viewing:Commercial Garage for Auto Repair·Size30×60·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$29,850$34,050Save $4,200
or as low as $622/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×60
30×56
smaller
$28,000
30×60
this size
$29,850
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,800 sq ft enclosed
  • 12 GA Frame
  • Three 12×12 Roll-Ups
  • Vertical Roof
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X60-COMMERCIAL-GARAGBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-bay garage + shop.

30 feet wide × 60 feet long. Engineered for clear-span over multiple doors. Built for business owners who need fast permitted occupancy, this 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair packs 1800 sq ft into a code-compliant shell.

3 vehicle baysWorkshop areaStorage + lift bay30′ × 60′ · 1,800 sq ft · multi-bay garage + shop

3 vehicle bays · Workshop area · Storage + lift bay

3 vehicle bays at the front, workshop area in the middle, storage + lift bay at the rear. Capacity: 3 vehicles + full hobby shop. Independent auto shops spec a 30×60 commercial garage to run three lifts side-by-side along the 56-ft sidewall, with a fourth open bay for diagnostics.

💡 Pro tip:Three 12×12 Roll-Ups. Size affords: 2-post lift, separated workshop, office.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×60 Commercial Garage for Auto Repair in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Commercial Garage for Auto Repair.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,800 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Commercial Garage for Auto Repair spec sheet.

Width30′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,800 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Commercial Garage for Auto Repair.

DAILY USEEveryday commercial garage for auto repair
Everyday commercial garage for auto repair
1,800 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a commercial garage for auto repair.
STORAGE OVERFLOWcommercial garage for auto repair + seasonal storage
commercial garage for auto repair + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×60 Commercial Garage for Auto Repair, what makes it different.

1,800sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$622/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $622/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×60?

1,800 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 60′ footprint with 1,800 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $14,400–$21,600 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Commercial Garage for Auto Repair shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×60 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×60 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×60 Commercial Garage for Auto Repair buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×60 Commercial Garage for Auto Repair

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Commercial Garage for Auto Repair · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×61×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$8,100+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Commercial Garage for Auto Repair also viewed:

🏢 30×60

Fleet Van Storage Building

30×60 fleet van storage building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Fleet Van Storage Building →

🏭 30×60

Fabrication Shop

30×60 fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$30,250Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Fabrication Shop →

🏡 30×60

Metal Barndominium Shell

30×60 metal barndominium shell configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barndominium Shell →

🌾 30×60

Horse Barn with Stalls

30×60 horse barn with stalls configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Horse Barn with Stalls →

🏭 30×60

Equipment Storage Building

30×60 equipment storage building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$30,250Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equipment Storage Building →

🌾 30×60

Round Bale and Tractor Storage

30×60 round bale and tractor storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Round Bale and Tractor Storage →

🏢 30×60

Contractor Workshop and Office

30×60 contractor workshop and office configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Workshop and Office →

🎯 30×60

RV and Boat Storage

30×60 rv and boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV and Boat Storage →

🏡 30×60

Hobbyist Workshop with Loft

30×60 hobbyist workshop with loft configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobbyist Workshop with Loft →

🏢 30×60

Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse

30×60 self-storage mini-warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse →

🌾 30×60

Farm Workshop and Implement Shed

30×60 farm workshop and implement shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Farm Workshop and Implement Shed →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Commercial Garage for Auto Repair questions, answered.

How much does a 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair cost?

A 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair from Steel and Stud starts at $29,850 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $622/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud commercial garage for auto repair ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair?

Almost always for 1,800+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud commercial garage for auto repair different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $622/month on a 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair.

What warranty comes with the 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does the 30×60 commercial garage for auto repair meet IBC commercial code?

Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.

Ready to build?

Your Commercial Garage for Auto Repair quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$29,850.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Black steel garage workshop with open bay, classic car inside, and vintage motorcycle

30×60 Commercial Garage for Auto Repair

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$29,850.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Matte graphite prefab metal building with monitor roof and white pickup truck at the bay

30×60 Fleet Van Storage Building

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×60 Fleet Van Storage Building | Steel and Stud, From $29,850

12

30×60 Fleet Van Storage Building
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$34,050$29,850SAVE $4,200
or $622/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×60Fleet Van Storage Building

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×60 Fleet Van Storage Building, engineered for code-compliant business use.

Looking for a 30×60 fleet van storage building? At 1800 sq ft, this footprint suits small businesses, retail, or service shops. Plumbing, HVAC, and electrical contractors park four Transit or ProMaster vans inside.

You’re viewing:Fleet Van Storage Building·Size30×60·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$29,850$34,050Save $4,200
or as low as $622/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×60
30×56
smaller
$28,000
30×60
this size
$29,850
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,800 sq ft enclosed
  • 4 Bay Layout
  • 14 GA Frame
  • Walk-In Door
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X60-FLEET-VAN-STORAGBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your fleet-garage layout.

30 feet wide × 60 feet long. Looking for a 30×60 fleet van storage building? At 1800 sq ft, this footprint suits small businesses, retail, or service shops.

↑ WINDOW WALL ↑Service vehicle 1Service vehicle 2Tools / parts30′ × 60′ · 1,800 sq ft · fleet-garage layout

Service vehicle 1 · Service vehicle 2 · Tools / parts

Service vehicle 1 at the front, service vehicle 2 in the middle, tools / parts at the rear. Plumbing, HVAC, and electrical contractors park four Transit or ProMaster vans inside overnight, with room for a parts cage at one end.

💡 Pro tip:4 Bay Layout.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×60 Fleet Van Storage Building in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Fleet Van Storage Building.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,800 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Fleet Van Storage Building spec sheet.

Width30′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,800 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Fleet Van Storage Building.

DAILY USEEveryday fleet van storage building
Everyday fleet van storage building
1,800 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a fleet van storage building.
STORAGE OVERFLOWfleet van storage building + seasonal storage
fleet van storage building + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×60 Fleet Van Storage Building, what makes it different.

1,800sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$622/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×60 fleet van storage building is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $622/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×60?

1,800 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 60′ footprint with 1,800 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $14,400–$21,600 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Fleet Van Storage Building shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×60 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×60 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×60 Fleet Van Storage Building buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×60 Fleet Van Storage Building

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Fleet Van Storage Building · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×61×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$8,100+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Fleet Van Storage Building also viewed:

🏢 30×60

Commercial Garage for Auto Repair

30×60 commercial garage for auto repair configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Garage for Auto Repair →

🏭 30×60

Fabrication Shop

30×60 fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$30,250Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Fabrication Shop →

🏡 30×60

Metal Barndominium Shell

30×60 metal barndominium shell configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barndominium Shell →

🌾 30×60

Horse Barn with Stalls

30×60 horse barn with stalls configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Horse Barn with Stalls →

🏭 30×60

Equipment Storage Building

30×60 equipment storage building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$30,250Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equipment Storage Building →

🌾 30×60

Round Bale and Tractor Storage

30×60 round bale and tractor storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Round Bale and Tractor Storage →

🏢 30×60

Contractor Workshop and Office

30×60 contractor workshop and office configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Workshop and Office →

🎯 30×60

RV and Boat Storage

30×60 rv and boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV and Boat Storage →

🏡 30×60

Hobbyist Workshop with Loft

30×60 hobbyist workshop with loft configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobbyist Workshop with Loft →

🏢 30×60

Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse

30×60 self-storage mini-warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse →

🌾 30×60

Farm Workshop and Implement Shed

30×60 farm workshop and implement shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Farm Workshop and Implement Shed →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Fleet Van Storage Building questions, answered.

How much does a 30×60 fleet van storage building cost?

A 30×60 fleet van storage building from Steel and Stud starts at $29,850 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $622/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×60 fleet van storage building price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud fleet van storage building ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×60 fleet van storage building?

Almost always for 1,800+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud fleet van storage building different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×60 fleet van storage building need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×60 fleet van storage building delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×60 fleet van storage building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $622/month on a 30×60 fleet van storage building.

What warranty comes with the 30×60 fleet van storage building?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×60 fleet van storage building in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does the 30×60 fleet van storage building meet IBC commercial code?

Yes. Steel and Stud’s 12-gauge frame upgrade and 26-gauge sheeting both meet IBC commercial standards, and most counties accept our stamped drawings without revision. Engineered loads ship with the order, typical certified specs are 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow.

Ready to build?

Your Fleet Van Storage Building quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$29,850.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Matte graphite prefab metal building with monitor roof and white pickup truck at the bay

30×60 Fleet Van Storage Building

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$29,850.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Charcoal metal workshop with vertical panels and flatbed truck delivering steel beams outside

30×60 Fabrication Shop

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×60 Fabrication Shop | Steel and Stud, From $30,250

12

30×60 Fabrication Shop
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$34,500$30,250SAVE $4,250
or $630/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×60Fabrication Shop

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×60 Fabrication Shop, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.

Looking for a 30×60 fabrication shop? At 1800 sq ft, this footprint suits fabrication, heavy machinery, or warehousing. Welders and metal fabricators pick 16-20 ft walls to fit a 5-ton bridge crane along the 56-ft.

You’re viewing:Fabrication Shop·Size30×60·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$30,250$34,500Save $4,250
or as low as $630/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×60
30×56
smaller
$28,400
30×60
this size
$30,250
36×60
wider
$29,600
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,800 sq ft enclosed
  • 12 GA Frame
  • Crane-Ready Engineering
  • 14×14 Roll-Up
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X60-FABRICATION-SHOPBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your multi-station shop.

30 feet wide × 60 feet long. Separates dusty + clean operations. Looking for a 30×60 fabrication shop? At 1800 sq ft, this footprint suits fabrication, heavy machinery, or warehousing.

Wood + metal benchesCNC / TABLE-SAW CENTERFinishing room + Material storage30′ × 60′ · 1,800 sq ft · multi-station shop

Wood + metal benches · CNC / table-saw center · Finishing room + Material storage

Wood + metal benches at the front, cnc / table-saw center in the middle, finishing room + material storage at the rear. Capacity: multi-craft shop / small business. Welders and metal fabricators pick 16-20 ft walls to fit a 5-ton bridge crane along the 56-ft length.

💡 Pro tip:Crane-Ready Engineering. Size affords: CNC table, paint booth, office.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×60 Fabrication Shop in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Fabrication Shop.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,800 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Fabrication Shop spec sheet.

Width30′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,800 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Fabrication Shop.

DAILY USEEveryday fabrication shop
Everyday fabrication shop
1,800 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a fabrication shop.
STORAGE OVERFLOWfabrication shop + seasonal storage
fabrication shop + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×60 Fabrication Shop, what makes it different.

1,800sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$630/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×60 fabrication shop is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $630/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×60?

1,800 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 60′ footprint with 1,800 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $14,400–$21,600 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Fabrication Shop shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×60 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×60 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×60 Fabrication Shop buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×60 Fabrication Shop

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Fabrication Shop · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×61×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$8,100+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Fabrication Shop also viewed:

🏢 30×60

Commercial Garage for Auto Repair

30×60 commercial garage for auto repair configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Garage for Auto Repair →

🏢 30×60

Fleet Van Storage Building

30×60 fleet van storage building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Fleet Van Storage Building →

🏡 30×60

Metal Barndominium Shell

30×60 metal barndominium shell configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barndominium Shell →

🌾 30×60

Horse Barn with Stalls

30×60 horse barn with stalls configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Horse Barn with Stalls →

🏭 30×60

Equipment Storage Building

30×60 equipment storage building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$30,250Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equipment Storage Building →

🌾 30×60

Round Bale and Tractor Storage

30×60 round bale and tractor storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Round Bale and Tractor Storage →

🏢 30×60

Contractor Workshop and Office

30×60 contractor workshop and office configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Workshop and Office →

🎯 30×60

RV and Boat Storage

30×60 rv and boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV and Boat Storage →

🏡 30×60

Hobbyist Workshop with Loft

30×60 hobbyist workshop with loft configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobbyist Workshop with Loft →

🏢 30×60

Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse

30×60 self-storage mini-warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse →

🌾 30×60

Farm Workshop and Implement Shed

30×60 farm workshop and implement shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Farm Workshop and Implement Shed →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Fabrication Shop questions, answered.

How much does a 30×60 fabrication shop cost?

A 30×60 fabrication shop from Steel and Stud starts at $30,250 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $630/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×60 fabrication shop price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud fabrication shop ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×60 fabrication shop?

Almost always for 1,800+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud fabrication shop different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×60 fabrication shop need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×60 fabrication shop delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×60 fabrication shop without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $630/month on a 30×60 fabrication shop.

What warranty comes with the 30×60 fabrication shop?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×60 fabrication shop in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×60 fabrication shop handle heavy equipment and forklifts?

Standard 30×60 fabrication shop ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.

Ready to build?

Your Fabrication Shop quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$30,250.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Charcoal metal workshop with vertical panels and flatbed truck delivering steel beams outside

30×60 Fabrication Shop

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$30,250.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
30x60 metal building: hero render — building exterior view, 1,800 sq ft Steel and Stud factory direct

30×60 Metal Barndominium Shell

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×60 Metal Barndominium Shell | Steel and Stud, From $28,000

12

30×60 Metal Barndominium Shell
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$31,900$28,000SAVE $3,900
or $583/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×60Metal Barndominium Shell

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×60 Metal Barndominium Shell, built for daily backyard use.

Looking for a 30×60 metal barndominium shell? At 1800 sq ft, this footprint suits homeowners adding garage, workshop, or hobby space. Barndo builders use the 30×60 footprint to split living quarters (roughly 1800 sq ft).

You’re viewing:Metal Barndominium Shell·Size30×60·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$28,000$31,900Save $3,900
or as low as $583/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×60
30×56
smaller
$26,150
30×60
this size
$28,000
36×60
wider
$27,350
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,800 sq ft enclosed
  • IRC Certified
  • R-19 Insulation
  • Vertical Roof
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X60-METAL-BARNDOMINIBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your barndominium shell.

30 feet wide × 60 feet long. Looking for a 30×60 metal barndominium shell? At 1800 sq ft, this footprint suits homeowners adding garage, workshop, or hobby space.

Bedroom(s)Great room / KitchenBath / Mech30′ × 60′ · 1,800 sq ft · barndominium shell

Bedroom(s) · Great room / Kitchen · Bath / Mech

Bedroom(s) at the front, great room / kitchen in the middle, bath / mech at the rear. Barndo builders use the 30×60 footprint to split living quarters (roughly 1800 sq ft) from a 2-bay garage and workshop.

💡 Pro tip:IRC Certified.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×60 Metal Barndominium Shell in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Metal Barndominium Shell.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,800 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Metal Barndominium Shell spec sheet.

Width30′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,800 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Metal Barndominium Shell.

DAILY USEEveryday metal barndominium shell
Everyday metal barndominium shell
1,800 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a metal barndominium shell.
STORAGE OVERFLOWmetal barndominium shell + seasonal storage
metal barndominium shell + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×60 Metal Barndominium Shell, what makes it different.

1,800sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$583/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×60 metal barndominium shell is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $583/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×60?

1,800 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 60′ footprint with 1,800 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $14,400–$21,600 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Metal Barndominium Shell shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×60 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×60 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×60 Metal Barndominium Shell buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×60 Metal Barndominium Shell

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Metal Barndominium Shell · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×61×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$8,100+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Metal Barndominium Shell also viewed:

🏢 30×60

Commercial Garage for Auto Repair

30×60 commercial garage for auto repair configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Garage for Auto Repair →

🏢 30×60

Fleet Van Storage Building

30×60 fleet van storage building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Fleet Van Storage Building →

🏭 30×60

Fabrication Shop

30×60 fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$30,250Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Fabrication Shop →

🌾 30×60

Horse Barn with Stalls

30×60 horse barn with stalls configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Horse Barn with Stalls →

🏭 30×60

Equipment Storage Building

30×60 equipment storage building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$30,250Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equipment Storage Building →

🌾 30×60

Round Bale and Tractor Storage

30×60 round bale and tractor storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Round Bale and Tractor Storage →

🏢 30×60

Contractor Workshop and Office

30×60 contractor workshop and office configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Workshop and Office →

🎯 30×60

RV and Boat Storage

30×60 rv and boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV and Boat Storage →

🏡 30×60

Hobbyist Workshop with Loft

30×60 hobbyist workshop with loft configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobbyist Workshop with Loft →

🏢 30×60

Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse

30×60 self-storage mini-warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse →

🌾 30×60

Farm Workshop and Implement Shed

30×60 farm workshop and implement shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Farm Workshop and Implement Shed →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Metal Barndominium Shell questions, answered.

How much does a 30×60 metal barndominium shell cost?

A 30×60 metal barndominium shell from Steel and Stud starts at $28,000 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $583/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×60 metal barndominium shell price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud metal barndominium shell ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×60 metal barndominium shell?

Almost always for 1,800+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud metal barndominium shell different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×60 metal barndominium shell need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×60 metal barndominium shell delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×60 metal barndominium shell without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $583/month on a 30×60 metal barndominium shell.

What warranty comes with the 30×60 metal barndominium shell?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×60 metal barndominium shell in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Does a 30×60 metal barndominium shell add resale value to my home?

An enclosed 30×60 metal barndominium shell typically adds $14,400–$21,600 in resale value per regional comp data, and most insurance carriers reduce premiums for indoor vehicle / equipment storage. Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust warranty transfers to the next owner.

Ready to build?

Your Metal Barndominium Shell quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$28,000.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
30x60 metal building: hero render — building exterior view, 1,800 sq ft Steel and Stud factory direct

30×60 Metal Barndominium Shell

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$28,000.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Tan metal building horse barn at golden hour with two horses grazing nearby

30×60 Horse Barn with Stalls

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×60 Horse Barn with Stalls | Steel and Stud, From $28,650

12

30×60 Horse Barn with Stalls
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$32,650$28,650SAVE $4,000
or $597/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×60Horse Barn with Stalls

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×60 Horse Barn with Stalls, built for farm and ranch demands.

30×60 delivers 1800 sq ft of rugged horse barn with stalls space. Farmers configure six 30×60 stalls down one 56-ft sidewall with a 12-ft center aisle and tack room on the gable end. The 30-ft width gives the aisle a.

You’re viewing:Horse Barn with Stalls·Size30×60·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$28,650$32,650Save $4,000
or as low as $597/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×60
30×56
smaller
$26,800
30×60
this size
$28,650
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,800 sq ft enclosed
  • Sliding Barn Doors
  • 6-Stall Layout
  • 14 GA Frame
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X60-HORSE-BARN-STALLBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your shedrow horse barn.

30 feet wide × 60 feet long. Center-aisle layout with cross-ties. 30×60 delivers 1800 sq ft of rugged horse barn with stalls space.

4 stalls10-FT CENTER AISLETack + Feed room30′ × 60′ · 1,800 sq ft · shedrow horse barn

4 stalls · 10-ft center aisle · Tack + Feed room

4 stalls at the front, 10-ft center aisle in the middle, tack + feed room at the rear. Capacity: 4 horses + tack + feed. Farmers configure six 30×60 stalls down one 56-ft sidewall with a 12-ft center aisle and tack room on the gable end.

💡 Pro tip:6-Stall Layout. Size affords: dutch doors per stall, wash bay rough-in, fly system.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×60 Horse Barn with Stalls in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Horse Barn with Stalls.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,800 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Horse Barn with Stalls spec sheet.

Width30′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,800 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Horse Barn with Stalls.

DAILY USEEveryday horse barn with stalls
Everyday horse barn with stalls
1,800 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a horse barn with stalls.
STORAGE OVERFLOWhorse barn with stalls + seasonal storage
horse barn with stalls + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×60 Horse Barn with Stalls, what makes it different.

1,800sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$597/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×60 horse barn with stalls is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $597/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×60?

1,800 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 60′ footprint with 1,800 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $14,400–$21,600 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Horse Barn with Stalls shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×60 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×60 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×60 Horse Barn with Stalls buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×60 Horse Barn with Stalls

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Horse Barn with Stalls · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×61×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$8,100+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Horse Barn with Stalls also viewed:

🏢 30×60

Commercial Garage for Auto Repair

30×60 commercial garage for auto repair configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Garage for Auto Repair →

🏢 30×60

Fleet Van Storage Building

30×60 fleet van storage building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Fleet Van Storage Building →

🏭 30×60

Fabrication Shop

30×60 fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$30,250Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Fabrication Shop →

🏡 30×60

Metal Barndominium Shell

30×60 metal barndominium shell configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barndominium Shell →

🏭 30×60

Equipment Storage Building

30×60 equipment storage building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$30,250Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equipment Storage Building →

🌾 30×60

Round Bale and Tractor Storage

30×60 round bale and tractor storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Round Bale and Tractor Storage →

🏢 30×60

Contractor Workshop and Office

30×60 contractor workshop and office configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Workshop and Office →

🎯 30×60

RV and Boat Storage

30×60 rv and boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV and Boat Storage →

🏡 30×60

Hobbyist Workshop with Loft

30×60 hobbyist workshop with loft configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobbyist Workshop with Loft →

🏢 30×60

Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse

30×60 self-storage mini-warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse →

🌾 30×60

Farm Workshop and Implement Shed

30×60 farm workshop and implement shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Farm Workshop and Implement Shed →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Horse Barn with Stalls questions, answered.

How much does a 30×60 horse barn with stalls cost?

A 30×60 horse barn with stalls from Steel and Stud starts at $28,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $597/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×60 horse barn with stalls price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud horse barn with stalls ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×60 horse barn with stalls?

Almost always for 1,800+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud horse barn with stalls different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×60 horse barn with stalls need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×60 horse barn with stalls delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×60 horse barn with stalls without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $597/month on a 30×60 horse barn with stalls.

What warranty comes with the 30×60 horse barn with stalls?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×60 horse barn with stalls in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×60 horse barn with stalls stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?

The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.

Ready to build?

Your Horse Barn with Stalls quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$28,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Tan metal building horse barn at golden hour with two horses grazing nearby

30×60 Horse Barn with Stalls

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$28,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
Forest green metal barn glowing at foggy dawn with a tractor parked in the lit bay

30×60 Equipment Storage Building

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×60 Equipment Storage Building | Steel and Stud, From $30,250

12

30×60 Equipment Storage Building
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$34,500$30,250SAVE $4,250
or $630/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×60Equipment Storage Building

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×60 Equipment Storage Building, rated for heavy-duty industrial loads.

30×60 delivers 1800 sq ft of heavy-duty equipment storage building space. Excavation and landscape contractors store skid steers, mini-excavators, and dump trailers under one roof. 14-16 ft walls clear raised dump beds.

You’re viewing:Equipment Storage Building·Size30×60·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$30,250$34,500Save $4,250
or as low as $630/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×60
30×56
smaller
$28,400
30×60
this size
$30,250
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,800 sq ft enclosed
  • 14×14 Roll-Ups
  • Drive-Through Layout
  • 12 GA Frame
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X60-EQUIPMENT-STORAGBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your equipment storage building layout.

30 feet wide × 60 feet long. 30×60 delivers 1800 sq ft of heavy-duty equipment storage building space.

↑ WINDOW WALL ↑Table SawBenchLumber Rack30′ × 60′ · 1,800 sq ft · equipment storage building layout

Equipment Storage Building layout.

30×60 delivers 1800 sq ft of heavy-duty equipment storage building space. Excavation and landscape contractors store skid steers, mini-excavators, and dump trailers under one roof. 14-16 ft walls clear raised dump beds and tilt trailers. Two 30×60 roll-ups at opposite ends let crews drive through without backing equipment in tight spots.

💡 Pro tip:Drive-Through Layout.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×60 Equipment Storage Building in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Equipment Storage Building.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,800 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Equipment Storage Building spec sheet.

Width30′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,800 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Equipment Storage Building.

DAILY USEEveryday equipment storage building
Everyday equipment storage building
1,800 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a equipment storage building.
STORAGE OVERFLOWequipment storage building + seasonal storage
equipment storage building + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×60 Equipment Storage Building, what makes it different.

1,800sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$630/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×60 equipment storage building is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $630/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×60?

1,800 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 60′ footprint with 1,800 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $14,400–$21,600 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Equipment Storage Building shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×60 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×60 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×60 Equipment Storage Building buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×60 Equipment Storage Building

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Equipment Storage Building · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×61×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$8,100+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Equipment Storage Building also viewed:

🏢 30×60

Commercial Garage for Auto Repair

30×60 commercial garage for auto repair configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Garage for Auto Repair →

🏢 30×60

Fleet Van Storage Building

30×60 fleet van storage building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Fleet Van Storage Building →

🏭 30×60

Fabrication Shop

30×60 fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$30,250Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Fabrication Shop →

🏡 30×60

Metal Barndominium Shell

30×60 metal barndominium shell configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barndominium Shell →

🌾 30×60

Horse Barn with Stalls

30×60 horse barn with stalls configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Horse Barn with Stalls →

🌾 30×60

Round Bale and Tractor Storage

30×60 round bale and tractor storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Round Bale and Tractor Storage →

🏢 30×60

Contractor Workshop and Office

30×60 contractor workshop and office configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Workshop and Office →

🎯 30×60

RV and Boat Storage

30×60 rv and boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV and Boat Storage →

🏡 30×60

Hobbyist Workshop with Loft

30×60 hobbyist workshop with loft configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobbyist Workshop with Loft →

🏢 30×60

Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse

30×60 self-storage mini-warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse →

🌾 30×60

Farm Workshop and Implement Shed

30×60 farm workshop and implement shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Farm Workshop and Implement Shed →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Equipment Storage Building questions, answered.

How much does a 30×60 equipment storage building cost?

A 30×60 equipment storage building from Steel and Stud starts at $30,250 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $630/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×60 equipment storage building price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud equipment storage building ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×60 equipment storage building?

Almost always for 1,800+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud equipment storage building different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×60 equipment storage building need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×60 equipment storage building delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×60 equipment storage building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $630/month on a 30×60 equipment storage building.

What warranty comes with the 30×60 equipment storage building?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×60 equipment storage building in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×60 equipment storage building handle heavy equipment and forklifts?

Standard 30×60 equipment storage building ships rated for 35 psf live load on the floor (over concrete pad), and the 12-gauge frame upgrade supports trolley- and jib-crane mounts up to 1-ton capacity. Steel and Stud engineers will spec heavier rigging on request, call 1-877-275-7048.

Ready to build?

Your Equipment Storage Building quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$30,250.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
Forest green metal barn glowing at foggy dawn with a tractor parked in the lit bay

30×60 Equipment Storage Building

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$30,250.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check
White prefab metal building with red roof and cupolas housing a tractor, ATV, and mower

30×60 Round Bale and Tractor Storage

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.

30×60 Round Bale and Tractor Storage | Steel and Stud, From $28,650

12

30×60 Round Bale and Tractor Storage
In stock · ships 3–5 wk
Starting from$32,650$28,650SAVE $4,000
or $597/mo · $0 down · no credit check

HomeMetal Buildings30×60Round Bale and Tractor Storage

★★★★★4.8(verified buyers)✓ Verified Buyers

30×60 Round Bale and Tractor Storage, built for farm and ranch demands.

30×60 delivers 1800 sq ft of rugged round bale and tractor storage space. Open-side configuration with two enclosed walls keeps airflow on the bales. Auger ground anchors handle rural sites without slabs.

You’re viewing:Round Bale and Tractor Storage·Size30×60·Slate Gray
Starting from your selected configuration$28,650$32,650Save $4,000
or as low as $597/mo · 0% APR · No credit RTO
ℹ️This is an estimate. Final pricing is locked after our sales team reviews your complete requirements (site access, ground type, county-specific certifications, optional upgrades). You’ll receive a written all-in quote within one business day of your request, no surprises, no hidden fees.
📐 Size footprint dimensionsSelected: 30×60
30×56
smaller
$26,800
30×60
this size
$28,650
📏 Side wall height interior headroomSelected: 9′
7′
8′
9′
10′ +$340
12′ +$640
14′ +$1180
🎨 Roof & trim color applied to building aboveSelected: Slate Gray
Slate Gray

🔧 Customize your build 9 options affect your price
🏗️

Roof Stylevertical sheds snow/leaves naturally
🚪

Roll-Up Doorsfront-mounted garage doors
🪟

Windowsnatural light + ventilation
🚶

Walk-In Doorside entry with deadbolt
🌡️

Insulation Packageyear-round comfort & energy savings
🔩

Frame Gaugestructural steel thickness
📋

Sheeting Gaugeroof + side panel thickness

Anchoring Typefoundation attachment method

Electrical Pre-Wireconduit run for licensed electrician
Customizations selected:
Customization subtotal:+$485
  • 1,800 sq ft enclosed
  • Open-Side Config
  • Ground Anchors
  • 29 GA Panels
  • 180 mph wind certified
  • 65 psf snow load
  • 20-year rust warranty
  • Free delivery + install
🚚
FREE delivery & installation in all 48 states. Concrete, asphalt, or compacted gravel.
SKU:SS-30X60-ROUND-BALE-TRACTBuilt:1,847+Since: 2002Made in: 🇺🇸 USA
🛡️
A+
BBB Accredited
4.8/5
customer rating
Since 2004
In Business
🏠
15,000+
Buildings
🇺🇸
48
States Served
We’ve provided builds for
FordAppleDiscovery ChannelU.S. ArmyGM
SPATIAL LAYOUT

See how 800 sq ft fits your equipment-barn layout.

30 feet wide × 60 feet long. 30×60 delivers 1800 sq ft of rugged round bale and tractor storage space.

↑ WINDOW WALL ↑Tractor bayImplement bayTool rack30′ × 60′ · 1,800 sq ft · equipment-barn layout

Tractor bay · Implement bay · Tool rack

Tractor bay at the front, implement bay in the middle, tool rack at the rear. Open-side configuration with two enclosed walls keeps airflow on the bales.

💡 Pro tip:Open-Side Config.
🎨 FREE 3D BUILDER

Build your 30×60 Round Bale and Tractor Storage in 3D.

Design your building yourself in our free Sensei3D Designer, drag doors and windows where you want them, swap roof + trim colors, and see your spec from every angle. Save your design and email it to yourself for later.

  • Drag-and-drop doors, windows, walk-ins anywhere on the building
  • 16 colors applied live to roof, walls, and trim, mix & match
  • Interior + exterior views of your spec, with measurements
  • Save your design and share it with your contractor or family
  • Auto-syncs to quote, what you build is what we price
✓ No login required✓ Works on phone & desktop✓ Used by 38,000+ buyers
Sensei3D Preview
LIVE 3D · DRAG TO ROTATE
, or,

📐 Use the Cold-Form Designer (engineer-grade specs)

WHAT’S INCLUDED

Everything in your Round Bale and Tractor Storage.

All variants ship with free delivery, installation, drawings, 20-year warranty.

🏗️
1,800 sq ft enclosed
Fully-enclosed 30×60 vertical-roof structure.
🚪
Roll-up + walk-in doors
Standard configuration door package.
🔩
14-gauge steel frame
American-rolled galvanized tubing.
🎨
1 standard color
Pick from 16 factory-baked finishes.
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Round Bale and Tractor Storage spec sheet.

Width30′
Length60′ + 6" overhang
Side height9′ standard
Floor space1,800 sq ft
Doors1 × 9×8 roll-up
Walk-inOptional (+$345)
WindowsOptional
Windup to 180 mph
Snowup to 65 psf
RoofVertical 3:12
Frame14 ga (12 ga upgrade)
Sheeting29 ga (26 ga upgrade)
AnchoringConcrete · Asphalt · Ground
Lead time3 – 5 weeks
USE CASE EXAMPLES

How real buyers use Round Bale and Tractor Storage.

DAILY USEEveryday round bale and tractor storage
Everyday round bale and tractor storage
1,800 sq ft is the right size for daily use of a round bale and tractor storage.
STORAGE OVERFLOWround bale and tractor storage + seasonal storage
round bale and tractor storage + seasonal storage
Park or store equipment in the front half, leave the rear for seasonal storage and overflow.
FLEX ROOMExpansion-ready
Expansion-ready
Stud-framed interior makes it easy to add a partition, electrical, or insulation later.

FULL PRODUCT DETAILS

30×60 Round Bale and Tractor Storage, what makes it different.

1,800sq ft
Floor Space
180mph
Wind Rated
65psf
Snow Load
20yr
Rust Warranty
40yr
Paint Warranty
$597/mo
From RTO
🏗️

Engineered for your county

Every 30×60 round bale and tractor storage is fabricated from American-rolled galvanized steel and engineered against the exact wind and snow loads your jurisdiction requires.

  • Standard: 140 mph wind / 35 psf snow
  • 12-ga upgrade: 180 mph / 65 psf
  • Permit drawings stamped and emailed free
🔩

Construction details

The same materials commercial fabricators use, not residential-grade. Hot-dip galvanized fasteners, factory-baked siliconized polyester paint, Hilti-grade anchors.

  • Frame: 14-ga (12-ga upgrade) galvanized tubing
  • Panels: 29-ga G-90 (26-ga upgrade)
  • Fasteners: #14 self-drilling with EPDM washer
🚚

Free delivery & install, really free

Regional-route delivery plus 1–2 day on-site installation by a certified crew, bundled into your headline price. No hidden unloading fees, fuel surcharges, or site-prep charges.

  • $0 deposit · pay only after walkthrough sign-off
  • 3–5 week lead time on regional routes
  • All 48 states · rush option available
🛡️

Warranty & lifespan

Engineered for a 50-year service life with industry-leading warranties on every wear surface.

  • 20-yr rust-through warranty on frame & panels
  • 40-yr paint warranty against fading + chalking
  • 1-yr craftsmanship on installation
💳

$0-down financing

Three financing paths to fit any credit situation. The rent-to-own option requires no credit pull at all, fastest path to a closed deal.

  • RTO: $597/mo, no credit check, 36–60 mo
  • Financing: 0% promo APR · 84 mo term
  • Cash discount: 4% on $10K+ orders

Why 30×60?

1,800 sq ft sits in the sweet spot for residential and light-commercial, fits standard quarter-acre setbacks, comfortably below the 1,000 sq ft municipal threshold that triggers extra inspections.

  • 30′ × 60′ footprint with 1,800 sq ft interior
  • Permit-friendly in 96% of US counties
  • Resale ROI $14,400–$21,600 added home value

PEOPLE ALSO ASK

Common questions from Round Bale and Tractor Storage shoppers.

The questions our team hears every week. Click any to expand the short answer.

How thick is the steel on a Steel and Stud 30×60 metal building?

Standard frame: 14-gauge (1.5 mm) galvanized tubing. Optional 12-gauge upgrade (2.5 mm) for high-wind/snow zones. Roof and wall sheeting ships 29-gauge standard, 26-gauge upgrade available on order.

Does Steel and Stud deliver and install in my state?

Yes, free delivery and free installation in all 48 continental states, performed by certified Steel and Stud crews. Hawaii and Alaska use custom freight quotes; call 1-877-275-7048 for either.

What’s the typical lead time for a 30×60 building?

Standard: 3–5 weeks from order confirmation to install completion. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery and 1-2 day install close it out. Rush builds available for $345.

Can I finance a Steel and Stud building without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals typically run 8 minutes with proof of income and first month’s payment. 36–60 month terms, no early-payoff penalty.

What’s covered under the 20-year warranty?

Steel and Stud’s 20-year rust-through warranty covers the galvanized frame against perforation, plus a 20-year paint-finish warranty against fade and chalk. Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Warranty transfers to the next owner on resale.

CUSTOMER REVIEWS

What real 30×60 Round Bale and Tractor Storage buyers say.

No reviews yet for the 30×60 Round Bale and Tractor Storage

Be the first verified buyer to share your experience. Honest reviews help other steel-building shoppers make a confident decision.

✍ Write the first review


HAVE A QUESTION?

Talk to a real metal-building specialist.

Our team has installed 15,000+ buildings. We answer technical, permit, and financing questions every day, usually in under 8 minutes.

Complete your Round Bale and Tractor Storage · Save 10% bundled

These add-ons ship and install with the same crew.

Browse all 28 add-ons →

Bundle & Save

🏗️
Concrete Pad Pour
31×61×4″ slab to engineered spec.
$8,100+ Add
Most Added

🌡
R-19 Insulation Package
Roof & wall batt, vinyl-faced.
$1,795+ Add
💧
Gutter & Downspout Kit
Seamless aluminum, color-matched.
$485+ Add
200-Amp Sub-Panel Pre-Wire
Conduit + sub-panel housing.
$695+ Add
CONSIDERING ALTERNATIVES?

Buyers who chose Round Bale and Tractor Storage also viewed:

🏢 30×60

Commercial Garage for Auto Repair

30×60 commercial garage for auto repair configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Commercial Garage for Auto Repair →

🏢 30×60

Fleet Van Storage Building

30×60 fleet van storage building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Fleet Van Storage Building →

🏭 30×60

Fabrication Shop

30×60 fabrication shop configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$30,250Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Fabrication Shop →

🏡 30×60

Metal Barndominium Shell

30×60 metal barndominium shell configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Metal Barndominium Shell →

🌾 30×60

Horse Barn with Stalls

30×60 horse barn with stalls configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Horse Barn with Stalls →

🏭 30×60

Equipment Storage Building

30×60 equipment storage building configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$30,250Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Equipment Storage Building →

🏢 30×60

Contractor Workshop and Office

30×60 contractor workshop and office configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Contractor Workshop and Office →

🎯 30×60

RV and Boat Storage

30×60 rv and boat storage configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize RV and Boat Storage →

🏡 30×60

Hobbyist Workshop with Loft

30×60 hobbyist workshop with loft configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,000Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Hobbyist Workshop with Loft →

🏢 30×60

Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse

30×60 self-storage mini-warehouse configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$29,850Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Self-Storage Mini-Warehouse →

🌾 30×60

Farm Workshop and Implement Shed

30×60 farm workshop and implement shed configuration, free delivery, free installation, 20-year warranty.

$28,650Vertical Roof14 Gauge
✓ Free Install✓ 20-Yr Warranty

Customize Farm Workshop and Implement Shed →

FREQUENTLY ASKED

Round Bale and Tractor Storage questions, answered.

How much does a 30×60 round bale and tractor storage cost?

A 30×60 round bale and tractor storage from Steel and Stud starts at $28,650 with free delivery and free installation across all 48 states. Most buyers pick the rent-to-own option at about $597/month with $0 down and no credit check. Call 1-877-275-7048 for a same-day price lock.

Is delivery and installation included in the 30×60 round bale and tractor storage price?

Yes, every Steel and Stud round bale and tractor storage ships with free delivery + free installation by a certified crew, included in the listed price. Anchored to a concrete pad, asphalt, or compacted gravel, your building is fully erected in 1–2 days after the truck arrives.

Do I need a permit for a 30×60 round bale and tractor storage?

Almost always for 1,800+ sq ft enclosed buildings. Steel and Stud emails engineered drawings stamped for your wind zone (up to 180 mph) and snow zone (up to 65 psf) at no charge, so your local building department has everything it needs. Permit timing typically runs 2–6 weeks by jurisdiction.

How is a Steel and Stud round bale and tractor storage different from a wood-frame build?

Steel solves the problems wood creates, no rotting, no termites, no warping, no painting every 3 years. Our 14-gauge galvanized frame carries a 20-year rust warranty and ships with a 180 mph wind / 65 psf snow rating already engineered in. A comparable wood build typically costs 2–3× more and needs ongoing maintenance.

What foundation does a 30×60 round bale and tractor storage need?

A 4-inch concrete pad poured 1 foot wider and longer than the building is the standard. Steel and Stud also anchors to asphalt or compacted gravel for open or semi-enclosed configurations. A pad-pour bundle is offered at checkout if you don’t already have a slab.

How fast can I get a 30×60 round bale and tractor storage delivered?

Standard lead time is 3–5 weeks from order to install. Fabrication runs the first 2–3 weeks at our US plant; regional delivery + 1–2-day install by a certified Steel and Stud crew closes out the order. Rush builds are available, call 1-877-275-7048 for current capacity.

Can I finance a 30×60 round bale and tractor storage without a credit check?

Yes, Steel and Stud’s rent-to-own partner does not pull credit. Approvals close in about 8 minutes with proof of income and your first month’s payment. Terms run 36–60 months with no early-payoff penalty, and the monthly works out to roughly $597/month on a 30×60 round bale and tractor storage.

What warranty comes with the 30×60 round bale and tractor storage?

Steel and Stud backs every building with a 20-year rust-through warranty on the galvanized frame and a 10-year sheeting warranty on the 29-gauge panels (upgradeable to 26-gauge or 12-gauge). Workmanship on the install is warrantied for 1 year. Full warranty terms ship with your order packet.

Can I customize the 30×60 round bale and tractor storage in 3D before I order?

Yes, our free Sensei3D Designer lets you drag and drop doors, windows, and walk-ins; swap 16 roof + trim colors live; and rotate the building in 3D from every angle. No login required. The design saves directly to a quote so what you build is exactly what we price.

Will the 30×60 round bale and tractor storage stand up to livestock and Midwest weather?

The 14-gauge galvanized frame is the same spec Steel and Stud uses for commercial barns, rated to 65 psf snow and 180 mph wind. Ventilation packages (ridge vent + soffit) ship standard on agricultural orders to prevent moisture buildup that would warp a wood barn.

Ready to build?

Your Round Bale and Tractor Storage quote takes one minute.

Tell us your zip and the options you want. We’ll send back a same-day, all-in price.

✓ 4.8★ · verified buyers✓ BBB A+✓ 24 years✓ $0 deposit · pay after install





$28,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from \/mo — No credit check
White prefab metal building with red roof and cupolas housing a tractor, ATV, and mower

30×60 Round Bale and Tractor Storage

1,800 sq ft for metal garage, workshop, or horse barn

30′ x 60′ 14 Gauge Local Certification Available
Pre-engineered 30×60 steel building delivers 1,800 sq ft of column-free space. Galvanized 14-gauge tubular frame, vertical roof, and certified wind and snow load ratings. Customize doors, windows, colors, eave height, and certifications in our free 3D builder.
Leg height adjustable up to 20'

$28,650.00

Free Delivery & Install RTO from /mo — No credit check

Not Sure Which Size? Build Your Carport in 3D and See Your Price Instantly

Flexible Payment Options

3 Ways to Pay - Pick What Works

No need to pay full price today. Choose from standard deposit, easy monthly financing, or rent-to-own with zero credit check. Every option includes free delivery & professional installation.

Monthly Financing

Affordable monthly payments, competitive rates.

Down PaymentVaries by lender
MonthlyAs low as $89/mo
Terms12 to 72 months
Credit CheckRequired
Best ForLarger structures
Check My Rate

Rent-to-Own

No credit check. Low monthly payments.

Down PaymentFirst month only
MonthlyAs low as $49/mo
Terms24 to 60 months
Credit CheckNot required
Best ForBudget-friendly option
Start RTO Application
Instant Estimate

RV Covers Price Calculator

Enter your desired dimensions and options below for an instant price estimate. Contact us for a certified, site-specific quote.

ESTIMATED PRICE RANGE $9,200 - $10,300

Estimate based on standard configuration. Contact us for exact certified pricing.

View Presets, Inventory Matches & Details

Presets & Calculator Data

Custom estimate

Enter a size and state to generate an estimated range and route correctly.

Size Selected 24 × 40 × 10
Floor Area 960 sq ft
Location FactorStandard
Inventory MatchNo exact match
Recommended Path3D Builder

Inventory Alternatives

4-8 Weeks Current Lead Time — 127 Carports Ordered This Month Alone

Why Steel and Stud

6 Reasons to Choose a Steel Carport

A prefabricated steel carport is the most cost-effective way to protect your vehicles, boats and equipment. Here is why 15,000+ property owners chose Steel and Stud.

🧮

Free Installation Included

Every tubular steel carport order includes free professional installation by a certified crew across all 48 contiguous states. No hidden assembly fees. Just confirm your site is level and we handle the rest.

🌟

20-Year Warranty on 12-Gauge

Our 12-gauge galvanized steel frames carry a 20-year limited rust-through warranty backed by the manufacturer. 14-gauge frames include a full workmanship warranty. Steel structures genuinely last decades.

💰

Factory-Direct Pricing

We work directly with multiple manufacturers, cutting out distributor markups. In most cases our prices beat the manufacturer's own direct pricing. 40-60% less than comparable wood or concrete construction.

🌞

12 Color Options Included

Choose from 12 standard powder-coat colors at no additional cost. Galvanized and primer finishes also available. Your color choice will not affect your price or lead time.

Engineered for Your Climate

All structures are designed to meet local wind speed and snow load requirements. 12-gauge certified frames are available for high-wind coastal zones, heavy-snow mountain regions and tornado-prone states.

🔭

Multiple Manufacturers, One Source

We partner with multiple vetted manufacturers nationwide so you always get the closest installer, the fastest lead time, and competitive pricing for your specific location and climate zone.

Choose the Right Roof

Regular vs A-Frame vs Vertical Roof Carport

Selecting the right roof style affects weather performance, aesthetics, price and longevity. Here is how each option compares across key factors.

Regular / Horizontal

Most affordable, simple design

Lowest starting price
Fastest lead time
Moderate rain and snow shedding
Horizontal roof panels
Not ideal for heavy snow areas
Best for mild climates

Vertical Roof

Best performance, highest durability

Superior snow and rain shedding
Panels run vertically top-to-bottom
No standing water or debris ponding
Ideal for heavy snow regions
Price premium (+15%)
Recommended for all climates
Verified Reviews

What Our customers Say

Real customers, real installs. See why 15,000+ property owners chose Steel and Stud for their RV Covers.

★★★★★
4.8 out of 5 based on 2,847 verified customer reviews
★★★★★

"Excellent to deal with — I feel fortunate Bill answered the phone when I called. He kept me informed of the order status from purchase through installation. Pleased with the quality and I would not hesitate buying again."

RB
Returning Buyer
Verified Customer
Steel Carport
★★★★★

"Bill is a hard charger when it comes to customer service. I was amazed how quickly he returned my emails and phone calls, and followed up with the installation from start to finish. Highly recommend."

VB
Verified Buyer
Verified Customer
Custom Metal Building
★★★★★

"Bill was very helpful with the sales portion of my order — communication promptly answered, straightforward about delivery. The installation team were professional and met every challenge head on. A well-prepared site is key; I'm thankful for his advice on that."

VB
Verified Buyer
Verified Customer
Steel Carport
Common Questions

RV Covers FAQ

Everything you need to know before ordering your steel carport: pricing, installation, permits, warranties, anchoring and dimensions.

Although this can be done with one person, we recommend having at least two people on hand to ensure safety. You can enlist the help of as many people as you like. All tubular steel orders from Steel and Stud include professional installation by a certified crew, so you do not need to self-install unless you specifically choose a DIY kit.

Carports and More Inc. has manufacturers that install in 48 contiguous states. Parts of some states are not covered by the manufacturer used for online pricing. If an order is placed and your location is not in a covered area, we will call you with the correct pricing for your area before proceeding.

Absolutely. You can install the building yourself. In most states, there is a 5% discount for self-installed buildings. The materials can be delivered to your location or picked up at the nearest factory. Contact us for current availability and self-install options in your state.

Manufacturers aim to install units within a 4-week period from the time an approved order is received. In some cases it is done sooner; however, it can take longer depending on the time of year, your location, and seasonal demand. Areas with extreme winter weather may close temporarily. Buildings over 24 feet wide require special construction and can take longer to manufacture.

Most standard RV Covers units are constructed in just a few hours. It may take up to two days depending on the size and complexity of the building. Large triple-wide or commercial-span RV Covers may require a second day for proper installation and inspection.

The key to a successful installation is a flat, level surface. Site preparation and building permits are the responsibility of the customer. You have approximately 2 to 3 inches of adjustment available during installation to account for minor grade differences. If your lot is significantly out of level, materials to level the site must be on hand when the crew arrives.

Re-bar and pin anchors (1/2-inch diameter, 36-inch long) are included for ground and asphalt installations. Concrete anchor bolts are used on concrete slabs at no extra charge. Mobile home auger anchors are available for ground installation at an additional cost. In several states, units enclosed on three sides require a minimum of four mobile home augers for ground installations.

Yes. You have 12 standard colors to choose from at no additional charge. Color selection does not affect your price. Galvanized and primer finishes are also available. Your color selection is made at the time of order and cannot be changed after fabrication begins.

Permit requirements vary by city, county and state. You should contact your local building department before ordering. All permit requirements such as set-backs must be resolved before ordering because once engineering plans are sent, your deposit becomes non-refundable. Generic engineered plans are available in most states. States requiring building-specific plans and calculations include CO, ID, MT, ND, NE, NJ, OR, SD, UT, WA and WY. Contact us if you have questions about your area.

The vertical roof allows water, snow and debris to run off quickly without ponding. The vertical panel orientation prevents accumulation and is especially recommended in high snow-load areas. If you are in a state with significant annual snowfall or heavy seasonal rain, the vertical roof upgrade is strongly recommended even though it carries a modest price premium.

Sizes are shown as width x length x leg height. Width is measured from outside to outside of each base rail. Length is measured by the roof metal, which includes a 6-inch overhang on each end, so the base rail is 1 foot shorter than the roof length. Height is measured by the actual leg on the outer wall. Standard-style roof units will be 1 foot taller at the sidewall than the selected leg height.

The frames are available in either 14-gauge or 12-gauge galvanized steel tubing. The roof, side and end panels are 29-gauge steel with a painted finish. Galvanized frames provide corrosion resistance. 12-gauge is 2.5mm thick; 14-gauge is 1.9mm thick. Lower gauge equals thicker, stronger steel.

14-gauge frame units carry a 30-day workmanship warranty. 12-gauge frames include both the 30-day workmanship warranty and a 20-year limited rust-through warranty on the framing, assuming normal user care and maintenance. Warranty coverage begins on the date of installation.

Yes; however, your deposit may not be fully refundable. You have 3 days from the date of order confirmation to cancel and receive a full refund. Cancellations must be in writing. After 3 days, deposits may be applied as credit toward any future purchase within 3 years. Deposits on custom-size units are non-refundable. Installation timing delays alone are not a valid reason for cancellation.

No. In most cases our prices are the same as or lower than ordering direct from the manufacturer. We work with multiple manufacturers and can often source your structure from the most competitive option for your location, size and timing, something a single manufacturer cannot do for you.

Yes. Extensions, lean-tos, sidewalls and doors can be added after installation, though there may be an additional service charge. If you plan to eventually enclose a RV Covers with walk-in or roll-up doors, your original leg height must be 6 feet or taller to allow for standard door frames.

Slab requirements vary by manufacturer. Please contact us before pouring your concrete slab to confirm exact dimensions and anchor bolt placement for your specific RV Covers model. Pouring the wrong size slab can delay installation.

12-foot legs are standard and available on all units. Longer legs may be available for special applications such as RV clearance or commercial-height requirements. Contact us if you need legs taller than 12 feet and we will confirm availability for your chosen structure type.

The balance due is paid directly to the manufacturer after your RV Covers is fully installed and you are satisfied. The manufacturer accepts cash, check and credit card. They will confirm accepted payment methods when they contact you to schedule installation. PayPal is not accepted directly by the manufacturer but can be arranged through Steel and Stud with applicable processing fees. If you prefer not to pay the full balance at once, ask about our monthly financing or rent-to-own (RTO) options — both are available and let you own your RV Covers with as little as the first month's payment down.

Yes — Steel and Stud offers three flexible payment paths: (1) Standard Payment — pay a deposit now, balance after install, zero interest; (2) Monthly Financing — competitive rates from $89/mo over 12–72 months with a soft credit pull; and (3) Rent-to-Own (RTO) — as low as $49/mo with no credit check required, first month's payment as the only down payment, and an early buyout option available at any time. RTO is available on most residential RV Covers sizes. View all financing options →

Gauge refers to the thickness of the steel tubing: lower gauge means thicker steel. 12-gauge is 2.5mm thick and is the stronger, more durable option backed by a 20-year rust-through warranty. 14-gauge is 1.9mm thick, lighter and more affordable, carrying a 30-day workmanship warranty. For heavy snow loads, high winds or long-term investment, 12-gauge is always recommended.

Standard single-car RV Covers (12x21, 15x21) start at $1,195 with free delivery and installation on tubular steel orders. Two-car RV Covers (18x21, 20x21) range from $1,595 to $2,595 depending on roof style and gauge. Triple-wide RV Covers (24x29 and larger) start around $3,895. Large commercial spans (20x38+, 24x45+) start at $5,195 and up. Contact us for a precise quote including your location, size and options.

Get Your Free Quote

Request a Free Carport Quote

Tell us about your project and a building specialist will contact you within 2 hours with a personalized, no-obligation price quote.

Why Request a Quote?

Fast ResponseAverage response time under 2 hours. Most quotes same day.
No Hidden FeesYour quote includes all standard features. Tubular orders include delivery and installation.
Low Deposit to StartDeposit varies by project scope. Balance due only after installation.
Zero ObligationGet your quote, compare options, decide when you are ready.
1-877-275-7048 Mon to Fri 8AM to 6PM EST

RV Covers Sizes and Dimensions Guide

RV Covers dimensions follow a standard width x length x leg height format. Width runs from 10 feet to 40 feet for standard tubular steel units. Length is effectively unlimited in increments. Leg height starts at 6 feet for standard single-car RV Covers and goes up to 12 feet as a standard option, with taller legs available on request.

Single-car RV Covers (12 to 15 feet wide, 21 feet long) are the most affordable option starting at $1,195. Two-car RV Covers (18 to 22 feet wide) are the most popular category, covering two standard vehicles with room to open doors. Triple-wide RV Covers (24+ feet wide) accommodate three vehicles, trucks, boats or large equipment.

When planning your site, remember that the base rail is 1 foot shorter than the roof length due to 6-inch overhangs on each end. If you need exactly 40 feet of enclosed coverage, order a 41-foot length RV Covers. Contact our team to confirm the right dimensions before ordering.

How Much Does a RV Covers Cost in 2026?

RV Covers prices in 2026 range from $1,195 for a basic 12x21 single-car RV Covers up to $9,000 or more for a large 30x50 commercial-span structure. All tubular steel RV Covers prices from Steel and Stud include free delivery and professional installation.

Key pricing factors include: Width (wider RV Covers cost more per linear foot), Length (additional bays add proportional cost), Leg Height (taller legs cost more), Roof Style (vertical adds ~15% over regular), and Frame Gauge (12-gauge adds ~12% over 14-gauge but adds a 20-year warranty).

DIY RV Covers kits cost less because installation labor is excluded, but most property owners find the free professional installation included in tubular steel orders to be a significant value. A crew that installs 50 RV Covers per week consistently outperforms a first-time DIY attempt.

RV Covers Installation: What to Expect

After your order is confirmed and your deposit placed, the manufacturer assigns an installation crew for your region. Current lead times run 4 to 8 weeks depending on your location, structure size and seasonal demand. You will be contacted within 60 days of ordering to schedule your installation date.

Site requirements before the crew arrives: a flat, level surface (within 2-3 inches), clear access for a delivery truck, and any permit posted or available. Concrete pads are preferred but not required for ground or gravel installations. The installation crew typically completes a standard single or two-car RV Covers in 3 to 6 hours. Larger triple-wide or tall-clearance units may require a full day.

Balance payment is made directly to the manufacturer after your RV Covers is installed and you are satisfied with the result. Financing and rent-to-own options are available through Steel and Stud for customers who prefer monthly payments. View financing options or request your free quote to get started today.

Related Metal Building Categories

Looking for something larger or more enclosed? Explore our full range: enclosed steel garages from $3,195, metal barns for agricultural use, tall clearance RV and boat covers, barndominium shells for combined living and working space, and all commercial steel building types. Every product category includes the same factory-direct pricing and professional service.

Ready to Protect Your Vehicles with a Steel Carport?

Join 15,000+ property owners who chose Steel and Stud. Factory-direct pricing with free delivery and installation on all tubular steel orders.

View Cart